Sony EXMOR PMW EX1 User Manual

3-278-905-13(1)  
3278905130  
Solid-State Memory  
Camcorder  
PMW-EX1  
Operating Instructions  
Printed in Japan  
© 2007 Sony Corporation  
matters please refer to the addresses given  
in separate service or guarantee documents.  
For the customers in the U.S.A.  
This equipment has been tested and found to  
comply with the limits for a Class A digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful  
interference when the equipment is operated  
in a commercial environment. This  
For the State of California, USA only  
Perchlorate Material - special handling may  
apply, See www.dtsc.ca.gov/  
hazardouswaste/perchlorate  
Perchlorate Material : Lithium battery  
contains perchlorate.  
equipment generates, uses, and can radiate  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed  
and used in accordance with the instruction  
manual, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. Operation of this  
equipment in a residential area is likely to  
cause harmful interference in which case the  
user will be required to correct the  
For the customers in the USA and Canada  
RECYCLING LITHIUM-ION BATTERIES  
Lithium-Ion batteries are recyclable.  
You can help preserve our environment by  
returning your used rechargeable batteries to  
the collection and recycling location nearest  
you.  
For more information regarding recycling of  
rechargeable batteries, call toll free 1-800-  
822-8837, or visit  
interference at his own expense.  
You are cautioned that any changes or  
modifications not expressly approved in this  
manual could void your authority to operate  
this equipment.  
http://www.rbrc.org/  
Caution: Do not handle damaged or leaking  
Lithium-Ion batteries.  
All interface cables used to connect  
peripherals must be shielded in order to  
comply with the limits for a digital device  
pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of FCC  
Rules.  
For the customers in Europe  
For the customers in Taiwan only  
This product with the CE marking complies  
with both the EMC Directive and the Low  
Voltage Directive issued by the Commission  
of the European Community.  
Compliance with these directives implies  
conformity to the following European  
standards:  
• EN60065 : Product Safety (AC adaptor)  
• EN55103-1 : Electromagnetic Interference  
(Emission)  
• EN55103-2 :Electromagnetic Susceptibility  
(Immunity)  
This product is intended for use in the  
following Electromagnetic Environments:  
E1 (residential), E2 (commercial and light  
industrial), E3 (urban outdoors), E4  
(controlled EMC environment, ex. TV studio)  
Pour les clients européens  
Ce produit portant la marque CE est  
conforme à la fois à la Directive sur la  
compatibilité électromagnétique (EMC) et à  
la Directive sur les basses tensions émises  
par la Commission de la Communauté  
Européenne.  
La conformité à ces directives implique la  
conformité aux normes européennes  
suivantes :  
• EN60065 : Sécurité des produits  
(Adaptateur secteur)  
• EN55103-1 : Interférences  
électromagnétiques (émission)  
• EN55103-2 : Sensibilité électromagnétique  
(immunité)  
The manufacturer of this product is Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku, Tokyo,  
Japan.  
The Authorized Representative for EMC and  
product safety is Sony Deutschland GmbH,  
Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327 Stuttgart,  
Germany. For any service or guarantee  
2
Ce produit est prévu pour être utilisé dans les  
environnements électromagnétiques  
suivants :  
E1 (résidentiel), E2 (commercial et industrie  
légère), E3 (urbain extérieur) et E4  
(environnement EMC contrôlé, ex. studio de  
télévision).  
• EN55103-2: Elektromagnetische  
Verträglichkeit (Störfestigkeit)  
Für die folgenden elektromagnetischen  
Umgebungen:  
E1 (Wohnbereich), E2 (kommerzieller und in  
beschränktem Maße industrieller Bereich),  
E3 (Stadtbereich im Freien) und E4  
(kontrollierter EMV-Bereich, z.B.  
Fernsehstudio).  
Le fabricant de ce produit est Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku, Tokyo,  
Japon.  
Der Hersteller dieses Produkts ist Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku, Tokyo,  
Japan.  
Le représentant autorisé pour EMC et la  
sécurité des produits est Sony Deutschland  
GmbH, Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327  
Stuttgart, Allemagne. Pour toute question  
concernant le service ou la garantie, veuillez  
consulter les adresses indiquées dans les  
documents de service ou de garantie  
séparés.  
Der autorisierte Repräsentant für EMV und  
Produktsicherheit ist Sony Deutschland  
GmbH, Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327  
Stuttgart, Deutschland. Bei jeglichen  
Angelegenheiten in Bezug auf Kundendienst  
oder Garantie wenden Sie sich bitte an die in  
den separaten Kundendienst- oder  
Garantiedokumenten aufgeführten  
Anschriften.  
Pour les utilisateurs aux Etats-Unis et au  
Canada.  
RECYCLAGE DES ACCUMULATEURS AUX  
IONS DE LITHIUM  
Les accumulateurs aux ions de lithium sont  
recyclables.  
Für Kunden in Deutschland  
Entsorgungshinweis: Bitte werfen Sie nur  
entladene Batterien in die Sammelboxen  
beim Handel oder den Kommunen. Entladen  
sind Batterien in der Regel dann, wenn das  
Gerät abschaltet und signalisiert „Batterie  
leer“ oder nach längerer Gebrauchsdauer  
der Batterien „nicht mehr einwandfrei  
funktioniert“. Um sicherzugehen, kleben Sie  
die Batteriepole z.B. mit einem Klebestreifen  
ab oder geben Sie die Batterien einzeln in  
einen Plastikbeutel.  
Vous pouvez contribuer à préserver  
l’environnement en rapportant les piles  
usées dans un point de collection et  
recyclage le plus proche.  
Pour plus d’informations sur le recyclage des  
accumulateurs, téléphonez le numéro gratuit  
1-800-822-8837 (Etats-Unis et Canada  
uniquement), ou visitez http://www.rbrc.org/  
Avertissment: Ne pas utiliser des  
accumulateurs aux ions de lithium qui sont  
endommagées ou qui fuient..  
Für Kunden in Europa  
Dieses Produkt besitzt die CE-  
Kennzeichnung und erfüllt die EMV-  
Richtlinie sowie die  
Niederspannungsrichtlinie der EG-  
Kommission.  
Angewandte Normen:  
• EN60065 : Sicherheitsbestimmungen  
(Netzgerät)  
• EN55103-1: Elektromagnetische  
Verträglichkeit (Störaussendung)  
3
Table of Contents  
Checking the Remaining Time Available for  
Table of Contents  
4
Table of Contents  
5
Registering the Customized Settings as a Picture  
Table of Contents  
6
Table of Contents  
7
Recording the Camcorder Picture on an External  
Table of Contents  
8
Overview  
Package Configuration  
Make sure you have following items supplied with your camcorder.  
The number in parentheses indicates the number of that item supplied.  
BP-U30 battery pack (1)  
Lens hood with lens cap (1)  
B
P
-
S
3
0
BC-U1 battery charger (1)  
It is attached to the camcorder at the factory.  
If you attach an optional wide-conversion lens,  
remove the lens hood.  
Large eyecup (1)  
Infrared Remote  
Commander (1)  
D
C
O
U
T
C
H
A
R
G
E
0
%
B
A
B
C
8
0
T
T
E
R
1
1
0
-U  
Y
0
C
H
A
R
G
E
R
PUSH SET  
1
SHOTMARK  
2
T
ZOOM  
W
Shoulder strap (1)  
THUMBNAIL SUB CLIP  
PREV  
PLAY/PAUSE  
NEXT  
STOP  
.
u
>
x
FREV  
FFWD  
m
M
REC  
REC  
PAUSE  
PUSH AF  
z
X
It is attached to the  
camcorder at the factory.  
USB cable (1)  
Lithium battery (CR2032 for backup) (1)  
It is mounted in the camcorder at the factory.  
Lithium battery (CR2025 for the IR Remote  
Commander) (1)  
It is mounted in the IR Remote Commander at the  
factory.  
AV connecting cable (1)  
CD-ROM (1)  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software, SxS Device  
Driver Software, Operating Instructions in PDF  
format are included.  
Operating Instructions (This manual) (1)  
SxS Device Driver Software End-User  
License Agreement (1)  
Component video cable (1)  
Package Configuration  
9
     
1080 resolutions. Frame rate is also selectable  
from interlace and progressive (59.94i, 50i,  
29.97P, 25P, and native 23.98P). In addition,  
59.94P and 50P progressive recording is available  
in 1280 × 720 mode. SxS memory cards can  
simultaneously hold multiple files of any of these  
recording formats, allowing for flexible use of the  
memory cards.  
Features  
The PMW-EX1 is a highly compact and high-  
1)  
performance XDCAM EX camcorder that uses  
1)  
SxS memory cards, as its recording medium.  
High-quality uncompressed audio recording  
In addition to HD video recording, the PMW-  
EX1 can record and play back high-quality, two-  
channel 16-bit, 48-kHz linear PCM  
The imaging devices used in the PMW-EX1  
1
camcorder are three / -inch type CMOS sensors,  
2
each with an effective pixel count of 1920 × 1080,  
which produce images in full HD resolution.  
uncompressed audio.  
IT friendly  
A New Generation of HD Recording  
System  
The file-based recording in MP4 format allows  
material to be handled with great flexibility in an  
IT-based environment, easily available for  
copying, transferring, sharing, and archiving.  
New nonlinear recording media  
Using SxS memory cards, the PMW-EX1 offers  
nonlinear capabilities such as instant random  
access and file-based operation.  
For immediate recording start  
In recording on flash memory cards, the XDCAM  
EX system makes each new recording on an  
empty area of the card. This is extremely  
convenient, as the camera operator need not  
worry about accidentally recording over good  
takes or search through footage for the correct  
position to start the next recording.  
HD recording using the “MPEG-2 Long GOP”  
codec  
The PMW-EX1 records 1920 × 1080 HD images  
using “MPEG-2 Long GOP” codec compression.  
This mature “MPEG-2 Long GOP” codec, which  
1)  
2)  
is also adopted in the XDCAM HD and HDV  
1080i series of products, enables you to record  
Instant-access thumbnail display with “Expand”  
function  
Each time a recording is started and stopped on  
the XDCAM EX camcorder, the video and audio  
signals are recorded as one clip.  
stunning-quality HD video and audio with long  
recording time by efficiently compressing the  
data.  
Selectable bit rates  
Furthermore, thumbnails are automatically  
generated for each clip as a visual reference,  
allowing the operator to cue-up to a desired scene  
simply by guiding the cursor to a thumbnail. For  
further convenience, the ‘Expand’ function  
allows one selected clip in the Thumbnail display  
to be divided into 12 equal time intervals, each  
with its own thumbnail identifier. This is useful if  
you wish to quickly search for a particular scene  
within a lengthy clip.  
The PMW-EX1 offers a choice of bit rates: either  
35 Mbps (HQ mode) or 25 Mbps (SP mode),  
depending on the desired picture quality and  
recording time.  
Long recording time  
By utilizing an efficient compression format, the  
PMW-EX1 records high-quality HD images for  
long recording time of approx. 50 minutes in HQ  
mode (35 Mbps VBR) or approx. 70 minutes in  
SP mode (25 Mbps CBR) on a single 16-GB SxS  
memory card. Equipped with two SxS memory  
card slots, the PMW-EX1 makes transition  
seamless without any frame loss, when recording  
is done across two cards,  
Cutting-edge Camera Technologies  
1
1)  
/ -inch type three “Exmor” CMOS sensors  
2
The PMW-EX1 is equipped with three newly  
1
developed / -inch “Exmor” CMOS Sensors,  
Multiple-format recording  
2
The PMW-EX1 camcorder offers a wide array of  
recording formats for multiple content creation  
applications. The scanning mode is switchable  
among 1920 × 1080, 1280 × 720, and 1440 ×  
which deliver excellent picture performance with  
full HD resolution.  
Features  
10  
 
14x zoom lens  
Shutter-angle settings  
The PMW-EX1 is equipped with a zoom lens  
specifically designed for the camcorder to offer  
optimum picture performance. Independent rings  
for zoom, focus, and iris adjustment give the user  
a high level of operational comfort.  
In addition to the electric shutter speed controls,  
the PMW-EX1 also has a “shutter angle” control,  
which is familiar to cinematographers.  
Picture Profile feature  
The Picture Profile feature allows the camera  
operator to easily call up customized picture-  
tonal settings to suit particular shooting  
conditions.  
Versatile focus-assistance functions  
The lens has a versatile functions for easy and  
precise focus adjustments.  
• One-push Auto Focus  
• MF Assist  
• Expanded Focus  
Shot Transition function  
The Shot Transition function allows for smooth  
automatic scene transitions. The operator can  
program start and end settings for zoom, focus,  
and white balance into the A and B buttons, and  
with a press of the Start button a smooth transition  
will take place according to the set time.  
• Peaking  
• Optical Image Stabilizer (Steady Shot)  
Creative Recording Modes and Settings  
23.98P native recording  
The PMW-EX1 camcorder, a new member of  
Sony’s legendary CineAlta family, though  
A variety of functions and designs for  
high operability  
1)  
compact offers native 23.98P recording  
capability.  
• Depth-of-field indicator  
• Brightness-level display  
• Histogram indicator  
Slow & Quick Motion function  
• 3.5-inch color LCD monitor  
• Easy-to-see color viewfinder  
• Rotary grip  
The PMW-EX1 offers a Slow & Quick Motion  
function, commonly known as overcranking and  
undercranking in film shooting, which enables  
you to create unique ‘looks’ or special effects of  
slow- and fast-motion images.  
• Four assignable buttons  
• Zoom and recording start/stop operations  
enabled both on the handle and the grip  
• Long operating time with a battery pack  
• Wide array of interfaces, including USB and  
Slow Shutter function  
The PMW-EX1 offers a Slow Shutter function for  
capturing clear images in low-light environments.  
This allows the shutter speed to be changed to a  
maximum of 64-frame accumulation period.  
1)  
i.LINK  
• ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance)  
• Built-in ND filter wheel  
• Selectable gain  
Selectable gamma curves  
The PMW-EX1 provides various types of gamma  
identical to those of other CineAlta camcorders.  
• High-speed picture search: ×4, ×15  
• Freeze Mix function  
• IR Remote Commander supplied  
1)  
Interval Recording function  
The PMW-EX1 offers an Interval Recording  
function that intermittently records signals at pre-  
determined intervals. This is convenient for  
shooting over long periods of time and also when  
creating pictures with special effects of extremely  
quick motion.  
1)Sony, XDCAM, XDCAM EX, SxS, i.LINK, Exmor,  
CineAlta, and Remote Commander are trademarks of  
Sony Corporation.  
2)HDV is a trademark of Sony Corporation and Victor  
Company of Japan, Limited.  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective  
owners.  
Frame Recording function  
Frame Recording is a unique feature of the PMW-  
EX1 camcorder that is especially useful for clay-  
animation shooting. With this function, images  
for pre-determined frame are recorded each time  
the record button is pressed.  
Features  
11  
XDCAM EX web sites  
Using the CD-ROM  
For information on XDCAM EX, visit the  
following web sites:  
United States  
http://www.sony.com/xdcamex  
The supplied CD-ROM includes the following  
files:  
Canada  
http://www.sony.ca/xdcamex  
PMW-EX1 Operating Instructions  
The Operating Instructions for the PMW-EX1  
(Japanese, English, French, German, Italian,  
Spanish and Chinese) are provided in PDF  
format.  
Europe, Middle East, Africa, and Russia  
http://www.sonybiz.net/xdcamex  
Latin America  
http://www.sonypro-latin.com/xdcamex  
SxS Device Driver Software  
Australia  
Driver for using SxS memory cards with a  
computer having an ExpressCard slot.  
Information on installation of the software is  
included in the ReadMe (Japanese, English,  
French, German, Italian, Spanish, and Chinese) in  
PDF format.  
www.sony.com.au/xdcamex  
Asia (except Korea, China, and Japan)  
http://pro.sony.com.hk  
Korea  
http://bp.sony.co.kr/xdcamex  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
China  
Application program for operating clips recorded  
with XDCAM EX-series models on a computer.  
Information on installation and operations of the  
software is included in the User’s Guide  
(Japanese, English, French, German, Italian,  
Spanish, and Chinese) in PDF format.  
http://pro.sony.com.cn/minisite/XDCAMEX  
Japan  
http://www.sony.co.jp/XDCAMEX  
Reading the CD-ROM Manuals  
Preparations  
The following program must be installed on your  
computer in order to read the operation manuals  
contained on the CD-ROM.  
Adobe Reader Version 6.0 or higher  
Memo  
If Adobe Reader is not installed, you can  
download it from the following URL:  
http://www.adobe.com/  
Adobe and Adobe Reader are trademarks of Adobe  
Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
To read the documents  
Do the following:  
1
Insert the CD-ROM in your CD-ROM  
drive.  
Using the CD-ROM  
12  
       
A cover page appears automatically in your  
browser.  
If it does not appear automatically in the  
browser, double-click on the index.htm file  
on the CD-ROM.  
CPU  
Windows: Intel Pentium 4 2.0 GHz or higher  
(Intel Core 2 Duo Processor 2.0 GHz or  
higher recommended)  
Macintosh: Intel Core 2 Duo Processor 2.0 GHz  
or higher (Intel Core 2 Duo Processor 2.4  
GHz or higher recommended)  
2
Select and click on the manual that you  
wish to read.  
Memory  
This opens the PDF file.  
1 GB (2 GB or more recommended)  
Memo  
• Microsoft, Windows, and Windows Vista are  
registered trademarks and/or trademarks of Microsoft  
Corporation in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
• Intel Core and Pentium are trademarks of Intel  
Corporation in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
The files may not be displayed properly,  
depending on the version of Adobe Reader. In  
such a case, install the latest version you can  
download from the URL mentioned in  
“Preparations” above.  
Note  
• Macintosh and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc.  
registered in the U.S States and other countries.  
If you have lost or damaged the CD-ROM, you  
can purchase a new one to replace it. Contact your  
Sony service representative.  
Software Installation  
Do the following to install the software on the  
CD-ROM on your computer:  
System Requirements for Using  
the Applications  
1
Insert the CD-ROM in your CD-ROM  
drive.  
The following operating conditions are  
recommended for using the software recorded on  
the CD-ROM:  
A cover page appears automatically in your  
browser.  
If it does not appear automatically in the  
browser, double-click on the index.htm file  
on the CD-ROM.  
SxS Device Driver Software  
Applicable hardware  
Computer conforming to ExpressCard/34 or  
ExpressCard/54  
2
Select and click on the software that you  
wish to install.  
OS  
The installer for the software starts up.  
Follow the displayed instructions:  
Microsoft Windows XP SP2 or later, Microsoft  
Windows Vista, or Mac OS X v10.4.9 or later  
For details, refer to the User’s Guide or ReadMe of  
the software.  
For support information on the driver, refer to the  
following URL:  
Uninstalling an application program  
http://www.sony.net/SxS-Support/  
Windows computer  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
Choose “Start,” “Control Panel” then “Add or  
Remove Programs” and specify the program to be  
deleted.  
OS  
Microsoft Windows XP SP3 or higher (32-bit  
version), Microsoft Windows Vista SP1 or higher  
(32-bit version), or Mac OS X 10.4.11 or higher  
or 10.5.1 or higher  
Macintosh computer  
Drop the folder of the software (default:  
/Application/XDCAM EX Clip Browser) into  
Trash.  
Using the CD-ROM  
13  
         
Parts Identifications  
Camcorder  
1
2
Operation panel on the  
L
E
C
N
A
C
L
O
V
R
O
T
I
T
Handle  
E
/S  
D
W
N
L
E
S
F
O
M
F
E
S
IL  
A
N
B
M
U
H
T
U
A
/
P
T
X
E
N
Y
A
L
P
/
V
E
P
O
T
S
R
F
P
O
V
E
R
C
E
T
/S  
P
R
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
Upper operation panel  
3
C
W
E
E
I
R
V
E
R
A
T
S
H
N
S
IT  
R
A
O
T
IO  
B
G
N
N
LC  
D
B.  
LI  
2
.
HT  
O
TC  
D
/U  
T
1
UR -B  
IT  
IO  
N
O
A
/
4
5
FF  
8
S
T
A
D
B
A
T
TU  
IS  
P
LA  
FO  
S
T
Y
6
IN  
B
A
R
S
/C  
A
M
40  
L
E
N
S
IN  
F
IRIS  
O
B
R
T
D
5
IS  
P
H
2
IS  
T
O
G
R
A
M
0
0
1
3
1
N
D
R
M
A
N
F
U
IL  
A
S
TE  
2
S
IG  
IA  
A
U
F
D
N
F
E
T
O
O
M
3
5
1
M
A
C
A
5
RO  
R
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
A
IN  
Rear operation panel  
1
C
C
D
O
FF  
1
5 . 8  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
IL  
F
M
E
O
Z
B
R
E
N
U
B
R
A
A
C
C
ES  
P
E
S
A
K
IN  
S
L
G
OT  
F
SE  
T
U
L
IN  
L
L
E
C
A
T
U
T
T
O
X
O
M
A
F
F
E
N
U
A
U
TO  
O
T
U
A
L
L
A
U
N
A
M
G
A
I
O
IN  
D
C
-1  
S
U
H
A
-1  
H
-EX1  
PMW  
C
C
I
N
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
B
A
I
E
O
T
X
L
D
L
IN  
U
E
A
T
T
AU  
C
B
A
DIO  
E
E
L
EV  
O
T
N
P
R
L
U
A
A
M
S
T
A
U
2
-
Lens control block  
C
H
H
-2  
O
P
E
N
7
Card slot block  
Side operation panel (page 17)  
1. External microphone holder (page 54)  
2. Built-in microphone (page 54)  
3. LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) monitor  
To remove the lens hood  
1 Loosen the hood fixing screw, 2 turn the  
hood in the direction of the arrow, 3 then pull it  
out.  
B
I
T
I
H
T
O
S
N
A
S
R
T
4. Lens hood  
If you attach an optional wide-conversion  
A
CH-  
2
1
AU  
DI  
O
IN  
CH  
-2  
S
MIC  
T
S
R
O
A
T
LIN  
E
P
R
T
/
MIC  
+4  
8V  
M
IC  
LIN  
E
R
E
L
F
E
O
X E  
P
A
M
IC+  
48  
V
S
C
A
E
U
N
S
D
E
D
E
V
R
E
C
E
I
W
lens, remove the lens hood. (See the column  
at right.)  
5. Lens cap open/close lever (page 34)  
6. Rear tally lamp (page 35, page 123)  
7. Battery pack receptacle (page 22)  
1
3
Hood fixing screw  
For functions and usage, see the pages shown in  
parentheses.  
To reattach the hood, align the marks on the  
hood with those on the camcorder, turn it in the  
opposite direction from that when you removed it,  
then tighten the fixing screw.  
Parts Identifications  
14  
     
8
9
13  
21  
O
F
F
L
H
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
l
P
R
E
j
F
H
O
V
R
E
L
s
D
V
T
H
U
S
T
G
P
S
O
M
T
L
A
L
P
S
/
A
B
N
R
Y
T
R
/ P  
A
A
S
/
E
U
L
I
T
C
N
J
S E  
O
E
S
M
O
P
X
E
T
N
L
F
S
/
T
I
E
O
R
F
T
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
22  
23  
24  
M
A
C
/
S
N
R
A
B
O
L
F
N
I
P
Y
A
T
T
S
A
B
U
S
I
T
A
D
T
S
F
F
O
I
O
/
T
A
U
/
T
I
B -  
R
U D  
C
N
O
T
T
H
G
I
L .  
B
D
C
L
N
B
O
I
T
I
H
S
T
N
A
O
R
S
T
C
A
H
-1  
A
U
D
IO  
IN  
C
H
-2  
S
MIC  
T
O
S
L
IN  
P
A
T
E
R
T
/
M
IC  
+
4
8
M
V
IC  
L
IN  
R
E
E
F
L
R
R
E
E
A
E
M
IC  
B
R
S
V
A
L
E
I E  
T
+4  
8
T
W
E
C
V
R
E
Y
E
E
E
X
P
A
O
S
C
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
S
D
I
O
U
17  
Controls on the grip  
T
A
/V  
O
U
T
Cover of the lens  
control block (See  
Note” below.)  
Inside the cover  
COMPONENT  
WHT BAL  
A/V OUT  
OUT  
SHUTTER  
25  
26  
27  
18  
19  
20  
OFF  
ON  
ASSIGN  
4
8. Viewfinder (page 26)  
9. Eyecup (page 26)  
19. COMPONENT OUT connector (Mini D)  
20. USB connector (Mini B) (page 111)  
21. Accessory shoe  
22. REC/TALLY lamp (page 35, page 123)  
23. IR remote control receptor  
10. Eyepiece focusing knob (page 26)  
11. Headphone jack (stereo mini jack) (page  
55, page 81)  
12. i.LINK (HDV) connector (4-pin, S400  
conforming to IEEE1394) (page 114)  
24. AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 connectors (XLR)  
13. Hooks for the shoulder strap (left and  
and input selection switches (page 54)  
right)  
25. WHT BAL (automatic white balance  
Attach the supplied shoulder strap as shown  
below.  
adjustment) button (page 38)  
26. SHUTTER switch (page 43)  
27. ASSIGN 4 (assignable 4) button (page 57)  
For functions and usage, see the pages shown in  
parentheses.  
4
3
2
1
Note  
The lens is properly adjusted at the factory. Do  
not touch the controls of the lens control block.  
14. Built-in speaker (page 55, page 81)  
15. Grip (page 28)  
16. BATTERY RELEASE button (page 22)  
17. SDI OUT connector (BNC type) (page 110)  
18. A/V OUT connector (audio/video multi  
Parts Identifications  
15  
   
Operation panel on the handle  
Upper operation panel  
42  
43 44 45 46  
MONITOR VOL  
28  
29  
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
36  
THUMBNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
LCD B.LIGHT  
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
BARS/CAM  
37  
38  
ON  
OFF  
30  
31  
F REV PLAY/PAUSE F FWD  
j
G/S  
J
47 48  
PREV  
STOP  
NEXT  
l
s
L
32  
33  
39  
42. SHOT TRANSITION operation block  
REC  
START/STOP  
40  
41  
34  
43. LCD B.LIGHT (LCD backlight) switch  
HOLD  
44. LCD B.LIGHT +/– (LCD backlight  
adjustment) buttons (page 25)  
H
L
OFF  
45. TC/U-BIT/DURATION (time data  
35  
selection) button (page 53, page 80)  
46. STATUS button (page 89)  
47. DISPLAY/BATT INFO button (page 19)  
28. MONITOR VOL (volume) buttons (page  
55, page 81)  
48. BARS/CAM (color bar/camera signal  
29. THUMBNAIL button (page 79)  
30. PLAY/PAUSE button (page 79)  
31. F REV (fast reverse) button (page 80)  
32. PREV (previous) button (page 80)  
33. STOP button (page 81)  
switching) button (page 56)  
Lens control block  
49  
50  
51  
34. On-handle ZOOM button (page 46)  
35. Zoom speed switch (page 46)  
36. CANCEL button (page 95)  
37. SEL/SET (selection/set) button (Joystick)  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
52  
53  
54  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
It functions accordingly when you move it up  
(toward the subject), down (toward the  
viewfinder), left, or right, or you push along  
the axis.  
It is called “the joystick” in the subsequent  
operating instructions.  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
55  
38. F FWD (fast forward) button (page 80)  
39. NEXT button (page 81)  
40. REC START/STOP button (page 34)  
41. REC HOLD lever (page 35)  
49. Focus ring (page 48)  
50. Zoom ring (page 46)  
51. Iris ring (page 45)  
52. IRIS switch (page 45)  
53. MACRO switch (page 50)  
54. FOCUS switch (page 49)  
Parts Identifications  
16  
       
55. PUSH AF (momentary auto focus) button  
63. ACCESS lamps (page 31)  
64. SLOT SELECT (SxS memory card select)  
Side operation panel  
65. SxS memory card slots (page 31)  
66. EJECT buttons (page 31)  
Rear operation panel  
LENS INFO BRT DISP HISTOGRAM  
57  
ASSIGN  
1
2
3
67  
68 69 70 71 72  
ND  
FILTER  
OFF  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
2
1
MENU  
58  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
PICTURE  
PROFILE  
DC IN  
56  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
INT  
EXT  
CH-1  
CH-1  
59  
60  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
AUDIO  
IN  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
OFF  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
INT  
EXT  
CH-2  
CH-2  
L
M
H
B
A
61  
BATTERY  
RELEASE  
PRST  
PMW-EX1  
62  
73 74 75  
56. ND filter select switch (page 37)  
67. MENU (menu display ON/OFF) button  
57. ASSIGN (assignable)1/2/3 buttons (page  
68. SEL/SET (selection/set) dial (Jog dial)  
58. PEAKING button (page 49)  
It functions accordingly when you turn it up  
or down, or you push it horizontally.  
It is called “the jog dial” in the subsequent  
operating instructions.  
59. FULL AUTO button and indicator (page  
60. ZEBRA button (page 41)  
61. WHITE BAL (white balance memory)  
69. CANCEL button (page 95)  
70. PICTURE PROFILE button (page 70)  
62. GAIN switch (page 42)  
71. Power (CAMERA/MEDIA) switch (page  
Card slot block  
72. DC IN (DC power input) connector (page  
The SxS memory card slots and EJECT buttons  
are located behind the cover.  
73. AUDIO LEVEL CH-1 /CH-2 controls  
63  
74. AUDIO SELECT (audio level control  
mode selection) switches (page 54)  
A
B
SLOT SELECT  
CH-1  
ACCESS  
75. AUDIO IN (audio input selection)  
64  
65  
switches (page 54)  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
CH-2  
OPEN  
66  
Parts Identifications  
17  
       
Controls on the grip  
IR Remote Commander (Supplied)  
The buttons without remarks can be used in the  
same manner as the corresponding buttons on the  
camcorder.  
76  
S T  
O P  
S T  
A R  
T
R
E
L E  
R
E
A
V
77  
78  
79  
E
I E  
R
E
W
C
F
E
O
X
P
C
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
1
2
PUSH SET  
C
1
SHOTMARK  
2
T
ZOOM  
W
80  
9
10  
11  
3
4
5
6
THUMBNAIL SUB CLIP  
PREV  
PLAY/PAUSE  
NEXT  
STOP  
.
u
>
x
FREV  
FFWD  
m
M
LENS  
REMOTE  
REC  
REC PAUSE  
PUSH AF  
12  
13  
z
X
81  
7
8
76. REC START/STOP button (page 34)  
77. RELEASE (grip release) button (page 28)  
78. REC REVIEW button (page 57)  
79. EXPANDED FOCUS button (page 48)  
80. Servo zoom lever (page 46)  
1. ZOOM T/W (telephoto/wide-angle)  
button  
2. SHOTMARK 1 and 2 buttons (page 56,  
81. LENS REMOTE connector (page 47)  
3. THUMBNAIL button  
4. PREV (previous clip jump) button  
5. F REV (fast reverse) button  
6. PLAY/PAUSE button  
Bottom  
7. REC (record) buttons  
FOCUS  
MANU AUTO  
Press the z button together with the unmarked  
button (safety button) to start recording.  
PUSH AF  
8. REC PAUSE buttons  
Press the X button together with the unmarked  
button (safety button) to pause recording.  
O V S E R  
M A N U  
Z O O M  
9. PUSH SET button (four-way arrow key)  
It functions the same as the SEL/SET button  
(joystick) on the camcorder.  
82  
83  
84  
10. NEXT button  
11. STOP button  
12. F FWD (fast forward) button  
13. PUSH AF button  
82. ZOOM switch (page 46)  
83. Tripod receptacle  
Note  
Note  
Check that the size of the hole matches the  
screw of the tripod. If they do not match, the  
camcorder cannot be attached to the tripod  
securely.  
The SUB CLIP button does not function with this  
camcorder.  
When you use the remote commander, see “Using the  
84. Backup battery holder (page 120)  
Parts Identifications  
18  
       
On-Screen Indications  
Indications in Camera Mode  
When this unit is in Camera mode (mode for  
recording), pressing the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button displays the statuses and settings of this  
unit on the LCD monitor/viewfinder screen.  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button again, these indications are canceled.  
Remarks  
[M]: The indication of the items named with this  
suffix can be independently turned on/off  
with “Display On/Off” of the LCD/VF SET  
[A]: The indication of items named with this suf-  
fix can be turned on/off using the assignable  
buttons to which the corresponding on/off  
functions have been assigned (see page 57).  
[D]: The settings of the items named with this suf-  
fix can be changed using the Direct menu on  
the screen (see page 20).  
1
2
3
4
5
120min STBY  
A: 25min  
B: 50min  
Z99  
S&Q REC  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
24  
23  
HQ  
1080/24P  
6
7
S&Q Motion  
29/24fps  
22  
21  
74%  
High Light ND2 20  
W
hite Fader  
19  
18  
8
9
10  
TLCS  
.
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
MF  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000CH1  
CH2  
++  
ATW 4300K PP  
O
FF ND  
1
11  
12 13 14 15  
16  
17  
1. Battery remaining/DC IN voltage  
indication [M] (page 22)  
S&Q STBY  
Standby for Slow & Quick  
Motion recording  
zINT REC  
Interval Recording in progress  
Standby for Interval  
Recording  
2. i.LINK status indication [M] (synchronized  
with 3 and 4)  
Only when an external device is connected to  
the i.LINK connector, the status (zREC or  
STBY) of the device is displayed.  
INT STBY  
zFRM REC  
Frame Recording in progress  
Standby for Frame Recording  
FRM STBY  
3. Special recording/operation status  
indication [M] (synchronized with 2 and 4)  
4. Media status indication [M] (synchronized  
with 2 and 3)  
zREC  
Recording in progress  
Standby for recording  
Memory card in slot A is active.  
Memory card in slot B is active.  
STBY  
zS&Q REC  
Slow & Quick Motion  
recording in progress  
On-Screen Indications  
19  
       
5. Time data indication [M] (page 53)  
When the Direct mode is set to “Part,” the  
operation is limited depending on the GAIN,  
SHUTTER, or WHITE BAL switch setting.  
When the Direct mode is set to “All,” the GAIN,  
SHUTTER, and WHITE BAL switches are  
disabled.  
6. Media remaining indication [M] (page 33)  
7. Zoom position indication [M] (page 46)  
8. TLCS mode indication [M][D] (page 101)  
Backlight mode  
Note  
Standard mode  
S
TD  
When the indicator of the FULL AUTO button is  
lit, the Direct Menu operation is disabled for the  
functions that are forcibly set to the automatic  
mode in Full Auto mode (page 34).  
Spotlight mode  
9. Steady Shot indication [M][D] (page 51)  
10. Focus mode indication [M] ( [D] only in MF  
To operate the Direct menu  
Use the joystick on the handle or the jog dial on  
the rear control panel.  
11. White balance mode and color  
temperature indications [M][D] (page 38)  
12. Picture profile indication [M][D] (page 70)  
13. ND filter indication [M] (page 37)  
14. Iris position indication [M][D] (page 45)  
15. Gain indication [M][D] (page 42)  
Joystick  
Jog dial  
MONITOR VOL  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
MENU  
THUMNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
16. Shutter mode/shutter speed indication  
17. Audio level meters [M] (page 55)  
18. Histogram indication [M][A]  
19. Fader indication [M] (page 68)  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT LA  
IN  
A
T
US  
20. Video level cautioning indication [M]  
If the video level is too high or too low, a caution  
is generated showing the appropriate ND filter  
number.  
P
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
4
M
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
TO  
N
O
F
M
ED  
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
A
E
ER  
O
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
O
R
N
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
S
S
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AUT  
O
T
O
A
U
AL  
U
N
A
M
1
X
G
AI  
IO  
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
M
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
T
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
P
U
E
AU  
V
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
21. Depth-of-Field indication [M][A]  
22. Brightness level indication [M][A]  
23. Special recording mode indication [M] ([D]  
1
2
Press the joystick or the jog dial.  
only in Slow & Quick Motion Standby)  
If “Direct Menu” is set to “All” or “Part,” the  
cursor is displayed on one of the items for  
which the Direct menu operation is  
permitted.  
Frame Rec  
Frame Rec mode  
Interval Rec  
Interval Rec mode  
S&Q Motion  
xx/xx fps  
Slow & Quick Motion mode  
Example: TLCS mode indication  
24. Video Format indication [M] (page 36)  
TLCS  
7
On  
Direct Menu Operation  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
The settings of the items named with a suffix [D]  
can be changed using the Direct menu on the  
screen.  
Select “All,” “Part,” or “Off” for Direct Menu  
using “Direct Menu” (page 108) of the OTHERS  
menu.  
Tilt the joystick or rotate the jog dial to  
set the cursor to the item to be operated  
then press the joystick or the jog dial.  
On-Screen Indications  
20  
       
The Direct menu of the selected items  
appears.  
Example:  
Direct menu for TLCS mode selection  
TLCS  
TLCS  
TLCS  
74%  
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/200  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
3
Tilt the joystick or rotate the jog dial to  
select the setting then press the joystick  
or the jog dial.  
The menu disappears, and the new setting is  
displayed.  
On-Screen Indications  
21  
Preparations  
Power Supply  
You can use a battery pack or AC power via an  
AC adaptor.  
Removing the battery pack  
Hold the BATTERY RELEASE button pressed,  
slide the battery pack to the right to unlock, then  
pull it out.  
If you connect an AC power source, it has a  
priority even if a battery pack is mounted.  
O
N
O
B
F
L .  
F
G
I
H
Using a Battery Pack  
T
B
S
I
A
T
T
D
N
I
Y
P
F
L
O
A
D
C
U
U
/
R
B -  
T
B
A
A
T
T
I
R
O
I
S
N
C
/
A
/
M
S
T
A
T
U
S
OFF  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
Mount a BP-U30 or BP-U60 Lithium-ion battery  
pack.  
One BP-U30 is supplied with this camcorder.  
S
E
L
/S  
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
R
F
F
A
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
H
-
-
1
P
P
AU  
MANU  
IC  
R
T
T
U
F
O
R
E
O
IL  
AL  
D
C
E
INT  
EXT  
A
IN  
Power switch: OFF  
U
D
IO  
S
E
L
E
C
T
A
U
D
IO  
N
2
I
AU  
MANU  
T
O
AL  
INT  
Y
EXT  
TER  
T
BA  
E
AS  
LE  
RE  
Notes  
P
M
W
-
E
X
1
• Before use, charge the battery pack with the  
supplied BC-U1 Battery Charger.  
T
U
O
I
D
S
• A warm battery pack immediately after use may  
not be able to be fully recharged.  
BATTERY  
RELEASE  
BATTERY  
RELEASE  
button  
Mounting the battery pack  
Fully insert the battery pack then slide it to the left  
to lock.  
Checking battery charge remaining  
O
N
O
B
F
L .  
F
G
I
H
T
B
S
I
A
T
T
D
N
I
Y
P
F
L
To check during operation  
O
A
D
C
U
U
/
R
B -  
T
B
A
A
T
T
I
R
O
I
/
S
N
C
/
A
M
S
T
A
T
U
S
When recording or playback is in progress on the  
battery pack, an icon to show the current battery  
charge level and usage time remaining are  
displayed on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
OFF  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
S
E
L
/S  
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
R
F
F
A
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
H
-
-
1
P
P
AU  
MANU  
IC  
T
T
U
O
R
E
R
O
F
IL  
AL  
D
C
E
INT  
EXT  
A
IN  
U
D
IO  
Power switch: OFF  
S
E
L
E
C
T
A
U
I
D
IO  
N
2
AU  
MANU  
T
O
AL  
INT  
EXT  
Y
T
TER  
BA  
E
AS  
LE  
RE  
P
M
W
-
E
X
1
120min
A: 25min  
S&Q REC  
T
T
U
O
I
D
S
B: 50min  
Z99  
Battery pack  
receptacle  
Icon  
Remaining  
Battery pack  
100% to 91%  
Note  
90% to 71%  
70% to 51%  
50% to 31%  
30% to 11%  
10% to 0%  
If a battery pack that cannot be used with this  
camcorder is mounted, an error message is  
appears on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
Replace the battery pack with the BP-U30 or BP-  
U60, or connect a power to the DC IN connector  
after removing the battery pack.  
The camcorder indicates the remaining usage  
time in minutes by calculating the available time  
with the battery pack if operation is continued at  
the current rate of power consumption.  
Power Supply  
22  
                     
To change the message levels  
Note  
The Low BATT level is set to 10% of full charge,  
and the BATT Empty level is set to 3% of full  
charge at the factory. These settings can be  
changed with “Battery Alarm” (page 108) of the  
OTHERS menu.  
The operating time on a battery pack depends on  
the condition (new or old) of the battery pack and  
the ambient temperature.  
To check in power-off status  
Information on the mounted battery pack  
(BATTERY INFO) is displayed on the LCD  
monitor screen when you hold the DISPLAY/  
BATT INFO button pressed even if the  
camcorder is off.  
Using AC Power (DC IN Power)  
You can connect an AC power source to this  
camcorder by using the supplied BC-U1 Battery  
Charger for BP-U30/U60 as an AC adaptor, as  
shown below:  
The BATTERY INFO display goes off after 5  
seconds.  
DISPLAY/BATT INFO button  
F
L .  
F
G
I
H
B
T
B
S
I
A
T
T
D
N
I
Y
P
F
L
O
A
D
C
U
U
/
R
B -  
T
B
A
A
T
T
I
R
O
I
/
S
N
C
/
A
M
S
T
A
T
U
S
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
S
E
L
/S  
E
T
LCD B.LIGHT  
C
A
N
C
E
L
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
C
A
M
O
E
R
F
F
BARS/CAM  
A
M
E
D
IA  
ON  
OFF  
C
C
H
H
-
-
1
P
IC  
P
AU  
MANU  
T
U
IL  
T
O
R
E
E
R
O
F
AL  
D
C
INT  
EXT  
A
IN  
U
D
IO  
T
S
E
L
E
C
A
U
D
IO  
N
2
I
AU  
MANU  
T
O
Y
XT  
TER  
T
BA  
E
AS  
LE  
RE  
P
M
W
L
E
C
-
E
N
A
L
O
V
C
X
1
R
T
E
/S  
O
D
T
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
OP  
T
S
E
C
R
E
P
R
/
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
1
H
L
F
F
O
2
T
U
O
I
D
S
C
W
IE  
V
E
R
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
1.2  
OF  
/
8
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
I
N
8
C
.
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
N
L/S  
E
TU  
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MA  
O
FF  
NU  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
N
W
I
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
EL  
T
O
PRST  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
3
D
C
O
U
T
C
H
A
R
G
E
0
%
B
A
B
C
8
0
T
T
E
1
R
Y
1
0
-U  
0
C
H
A
R
G
E
R
BATTERY I NFO  
50  
BC-U1  
0
%
%
100%  
Re  
m
aining Ti  
m
e
:
20 in  
m
1
2
3
Connect the DC power output cable of  
the BC-U1 to the DC IN connector of  
the camcorder.  
If the battery charge remaining becomes  
low  
Connect the power cord supplied with  
the BC-U1 to the AC input connector of  
the BC-U1 then to an AC power source.  
If the battery charge remaining decreases to a  
certain level during operation (Low BATT  
status), a low-battery message, flashing of the  
tally lamps, and a beep sound will warn you.  
If the remaining further decreases to a level at  
which operation cannot be continued (BATT  
Empty status), a battery-empty message appears.  
Temporarily set the power switch to OFF and  
connect a power source via the DC IN connector  
or replace the battery pack with one that is fully  
charged.  
Set the mode switch of the BC-U1 to the  
DC OUT position.  
For details, refer to the Operating Instructions of the  
BC-U1.  
When recording or playback is in progress on  
power from the DC IN connector, the input  
voltage is displayed on the LCD monitor/  
viewfinder screen.  
Power Supply  
23  
                 
DC IN 12.0V 
A: 25min  
B: 50min  
S&Q REC  
Setting the Clock  
Z99  
Note  
When you turn the camcorder on for the first time  
after purchasing or replacing the backup battery  
(page 120), the Initial Setting display appears on  
the LCD monitor/viewfinder screen.  
Set the date and time of the built-in clock, using  
this display.  
The battery pack mounted on the camcorder is not  
charged even if you set the mode switch of the  
BC-U1 to the CHARGE position. To charge the  
battery pack, remove it from the camcorder and  
mount it on the BC-U1.  
INITIAL SETT  
Ti one: UTC +09:00 TOKYO  
ate / Ti e: 2007/01/01 00:00:00  
Fi nish  
I
NG  
Turning Power On  
me  
Z
D
m
This camcorder has Camera mode for recording  
and Media mode for playback.  
The mode is selected when you turn the power on.  
Time Zone  
Power switch  
The value shows the time difference from UTC  
(Coordinated Universal Time).  
OFF  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
Change the setting if needed.  
M
O
N
ITO  
T
R
H
U
V
O
M
B
L
N
A
IL  
S
E
L/S  
F
ET  
R
E
V
C
A
P
N
C
LA  
Y
EL  
j
/P  
AU  
S
E
P
F
F
W
R
E
/S  
V
D
S
J
l
TO  
P
s
N
E
X
T
L
S
T
A
R
E
T
C
/S  
TO  
R
P
H
H
O
L
O
L
F
D
F
-2  
CH  
IN  
O
Setting the time and date  
DI  
A
U
-1  
CH  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
R
E
LE  
A
S
E
R
T
N
S
H
O
A
A
S
T
T
I
O
I
O
N
B
N
O
B
Use the joystick on the handle or jog dial on the  
rear operation panel for setting.  
F F  
L .  
G
I
H
T
T T A B  
D
I
N
I
Y
P S  
R U D  
B -  
C
T
O
F
A
L
T
A
T
I
U
/
S
R
A B  
N
O
I
/
A
C
/
M
T
A
T
S
S
U
S
E
L/  
S
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
FF  
R
A
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
-1  
-2  
P
IC  
TU  
P
R
A
M
U
AN  
TO  
UA  
R
E
O
FI  
LE  
D
C
L
I
NT  
T
AU  
LE  
IN  
D
IO  
T
EX  
S
E
C
A
U
IN  
D
IO  
H
A
M
U
TO  
UA  
AN  
T
N
L
IN  
NE  
O
T
T
T
P
U
M
EX  
A
TTER  
Y
C
O
B
O
ASE  
T
U
RELE  
O
/V  
A
P
M
W
-E  
X
1
Joystick  
Jog dial  
T
U
O
I
D
S
To operate in Camera mode, turn the power on by  
setting the power switch to the CAMERA  
position.  
MONITOR VOL  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
MENU  
THUMNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
To operate in Media mode, turn the power on by  
setting the power switch to the MEDIA position.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
Turning Power Off  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
SIT  
AN OT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
M
4
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
Set the power switch to the OFF position.  
H
2
IS  
TO  
GR  
AM  
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
N
R
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
T
O
TO  
T
MANU  
FF  
AU  
TO  
O
Notes  
UT  
L
L
A
A
U
N
A
M
1
X
G
AI  
IO  
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
• This camcorder uses a little standby power even  
when the power switch is set to OFF. Remove  
the battery pack if the camcorder will not be  
used for a prolonged period.  
• When removing the battery pack or the DC IN  
power, be sure to set the switch to OFF in  
advance.  
Removing the battery pack and the DC IN  
power without first setting the power switch to  
OFF may cause damage to the camcorder or  
SxS memory cards.  
1
Tilt the joystick or turn the jog dial to  
set the cursor to “Date/Time” then  
press the joystick or dial.  
The cursor moves to the year-setting column.  
Setting the Clock  
24  
                   
INITIAL SETT  
Ti one: UTC +09:00 TOKYO  
ate / Ti e: 2007/01/01 00:00:00 SET  
Fi nish  
I
NG  
Adjusting the LCD  
Monitor and Viewfinder  
me  
Z
D
m
Adjusting the LCD Monitor  
2
3
4
Tilt the joystick or turn the jog dial to  
set the year then press the joystick or  
dial.  
You can adjust the angle and the display  
conditions of the LCD monitor for the best view  
in various shooting situations.  
These adjustments of the LCD monitor have no  
effect on pictures being recorded.  
The cursor moves to the month-setting  
column.  
Set the month, day, hour, minute, and  
second in sequence in the same manner.  
Turning on/off the LCD monitor  
The LCD monitor turns on when it is opened and  
turns off when it is returned to the park position.  
To open, pull the monitor out horizontally from  
the park position to rotate it 90 degrees.  
When you press the joystick or jog dial at  
“SET,” the cursor moves back to “Date/  
Time.”  
Move the cursor to “Finish” then press  
the joystick or dial.  
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
R
P
O
T
S
F
P
O
C
E
T
S
/
T
V
E
R
R
P
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
The Initial Setting display disappears, and the  
clock setting is completed.  
2
.
1
8
The camcorder enters the operation mode  
(Camera mode or Media mode) you selected with  
the power switch.  
ft  
m
40  
m
L
E
N
S
IN  
FO  
IRIS  
B
R
T
DI  
S
5
2
0
Once after the Initial Setting display disappears,  
the time zone and date/time settings can be  
changed using “Time Zone” (page 106) and  
“Clock Set” (page 107) of the OTHERS menu.  
Adjusting the angle  
Rotate the opened LCD monitor to the desired  
angle.  
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
R
P
O
T
S
F
P
O
C
E
T
/S  
T
V
E
R
R
P
R
A
T
Notes  
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
• If the clock setting is cleared because of  
exhaustion of the backup battery while no  
operation power was being supplied (no battery  
pack and no DC IN connection), the Initial  
Setting display will be displayed when you turn  
the camcorder on at the next opportunity.  
• While the Initial Setting display is shown, no  
other operation except turning the power off is  
permitted until you finish the setting for this  
display.  
.2  
1
8
ft  
40  
mm  
L
E
N
S
IN  
FO  
IRIS  
B
R
T
DI  
S
5
2
0
It can be rotated as much as 90 degrees in the  
direction facing the subject and as much as 180  
degrees in the opposite direction.  
When you rotate it 90 degrees toward the subject,  
the image on the monitor becomes upside down,  
indicating the mirror image of the subject. The  
display direction of the textual information is  
converted to the readable direction.  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
25  
       
V
E
E
S
/
T
R
R
R
P
LCD/VF SET  
Return  
LCD  
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
180°  
Return  
H
L
F
F
O
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
C
olor  
ont rast  
:
:
0
0
0
EVF  
Peaking  
Brightness:  
00:00  
Marker  
Zebra  
Display  
90°  
On/Of f  
Set color, contrast and brightness of the LCD  
monitor with the corresponding LCD menu  
items: Color, Contrast, and Brightness  
Adjusting the backlight  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
LCD B.LIGHT + and – buttons  
LCD B.LIGHT switch  
Adjusting the Viewfinder  
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
If the picture on the LCD monitor is hard to view  
under bright ambient light, you can use the  
viewfinder to check the picture.  
LCD B.LIGHT  
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
BARS/CAM  
ON  
OFF  
You can adjust the display conditions of the  
viewfinder according to your current lighting  
conditions.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
S
P
R
/
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
These adjustments of the viewfinder have no  
effect on pictures being recorded.  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
R
M
AN  
U
FIL  
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
 0
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
CA  
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
E
TU  
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
F
ILE  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
Caution  
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AUT  
O
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
-1  
H
-E  
W
C
C
W
IN  
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
Do not leave the camcorder with the eyepiece of  
the viewfinder facing the sun. Direct sunlight can  
enter through the eyepiece, be focused in the  
viewfinder, and cause fire.  
O
PE  
N
Turning the backlight on/off  
The backlight may not be necessary for viewing  
images on the LCD monitor under bright ambient  
light, such as in an outdoor location. Set the LCD  
B.LIGHT switch to OFF to turn off the backlight.  
Hereafter the viewfinder is referred to as “EVF”  
(abbreviation of Electronic Viewfinder).  
Turning the EVF on/off  
Adjusting the brightness of the backlight  
When you set the LCD B.LIGHT switch to ON,  
you can adjust the brightness of the backlight,  
using the LCD B.LIGHT + and – buttons.  
Press the – button to darken the backlight. Press  
the + button to make it brighter.  
With the factory setting, the EVF is turned on  
when the LCD monitor is in its park position or is  
rotated to face the subject.  
You can change the setting so that the EVF is  
always on regardless of the status of the LCD  
monitor, using “EVF” (page 104) of the LCD/VF  
SET menu. Change the “Power” setting from  
“Auto” to “On.”  
During adjustment, the backlight level bar  
appears to indicate the adjustment value.  
Adjusting the color, contrast, and  
brightness  
Adjusting the focus in the viewfinder  
The eyepiece focusing (diopter compensation)  
knob enables adjustment to match the eyesight of  
operator so that the operator can view the image  
clearly in the eyepiece.  
These adjustments can be made using the LCD/  
VF SET menu.  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode and select  
(LCD/VF SET  
menu) then “LCD” from the menu.  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
26  
                     
Using the eyecup (supplied)  
A large eyecup is attached to the EVF at the  
factory. It can be removed by pulling it out, if not  
neccesary.  
Eyepiece focusing knob  
To reattach the eyecup, stretch it a little to attach  
to the EVF and fit the rim of the eyecup into the  
horizontal groove of the viewfinder.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
A
O
ER  
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
ET  
O
/S  
RE  
FI  
N
U
EL  
T
O
A
S
FOCUS  
P
I
C
L
E
M
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
P
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MAN  
U
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Eyecup  
Adjusting the backlight  
The brightness of the backlight for the EVF can  
be switched between High and Low.  
Select “EVF” from the LCD/VF SET menu and  
set “Backlight.”  
LCD/VF SET  
Return  
LCD  
EVF  
Return  
Backl i ght : High  
B
B
B
B
B
B
M
ode  
ont rast  
Br ightness :  
er  
: Color  
Peaking  
C
:
0
0
00:00  
Marker  
Zebra  
Display  
Pow  
: Auto  
On/Of f  
Switching between color and  
monochrome modes  
For the EVF screen, color or monochrome display  
can be selected.  
Select “EVF” from the LCD/VF SET menu then  
select “Mode.”  
Select “B&W” if checking the subject and  
focusing are easier on the monochrome display.  
If you assign “EVF Mode” to one of the  
assignable buttons (see page 57), you can switch  
between color and monochrome by pressing the  
button.  
Adjusting the contrast and brightness  
Select “EVF” from the LCD/VF SET menu and  
adjust the contrast and brightness with the  
corresponding items: Contrast and Brightness  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
27  
       
Adjusting the Grip  
Using the IR Remote  
Commander  
The grip rotates approx. 120 degrees to support a  
variety of shooting styles.  
Before use  
Holding the RELEASE button pressed, slowly  
rotate the grip.  
Before you use the supplied IR Remote  
Commander for the first time, pull out the  
insulation sheet from the battery holder.  
-1  
H
C
IC  
V
48  
M
+
IC  
M
E
N
LI  
V
48  
IC  
M
+
IC  
M
E
N
LI  
R
E
L
E
A
S
E
Insulation sheet  
T R A N  
A
S I T I O  
T
S
N
H O  
O
N
O
D
B
F
L .  
F
G
I
H
B
T
B
S
I
A
T
D
T
N
I
Y
P
F
L
O
A
U
R
T
B
A
C
A
I
T
T
I
U
/
R
O
S
N
B -  
C
/
/
A
M
S
T
A
T
U
S
R
E
E
R
C
W
E
V
I
E
X
P
A
N
U
F
D
E
O
O
C
D
FF  
R
S
E
L
E
MEDIA  
DC IN  
A
S
E
ST  
ST  
AR  
OP  
T/  
E
E
Y
ER  
TT  
BA  
E
AS  
LE  
RE  
A/V O
M
W
-
E
A CR2025 lithium battery is set in the holder at  
the factory.  
X
1
Grip  
SDI OUT  
RELEASE  
To use the IR Remote Commander  
For controlling the camcorder from the IR  
Remote Commander, activate the remote control  
function of the camcorder after turning the power  
on.  
Activating/deactivating the remote control  
function can be achieved using the Setup menu or  
an assignable button.  
RELEASE button  
Click positions are provided at each 15 degrees.  
Release the RELEASE button at the desired click  
position to lock the grip.  
To activate using the menu  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, select  
(the OTHERS menu)  
and set “IR Remote” to “On.”  
O
C
THERS  
lock Set  
B
Language  
Assign Button  
Tal l y  
:
Engl i sh  
B
B
B
00:00  
H
ours  
IR  
Bat tery Alar  
M
eter  
O
n
R
e
m
ote  
:
B
Of f  
m
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
To activate using an assignable button  
Assigning “IR Remote” to one of the assignable  
buttons permits you to activate/deactivate the  
remote control function by pressing the button.  
For the assignable buttons, see“Changing Functions  
Adjusting the Grip / Using the IR Remote Commander  
28  
               
Note  
WARNING  
To avoid malfunctions, the remote control  
function is automatically deactivated when the  
camcorder is turned off. Activate the function  
each time when required after you turn the  
camcorder on.  
Battery may explode if mistreated.  
Do not recharge, disassemble, or dispose of in  
fire.  
CAUTION  
Battery lifetime  
• Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly  
replaced. Replace only with the same or  
equivalent type recommended by the  
manufacturer.  
• Dispose of used batteries according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
When the lithium battery’s power falls, the IR  
Remote Commander may not work even if you  
press the buttons. The average lithium battery’s  
service life is about one year, but this depends on  
the pattern of use.  
If pressing the remote control buttons produces  
absolutely no effect on the camcorder, replace the  
battery then check the operation again.  
ATTENTION  
• Il y a danger d’explosion s’il y a remplacement  
incorrect de la batterie. Remplacer uniquement  
avec une batterie du même type ou d’un type  
équivalent recommandé par le constructeur.  
• Mettre au rebut les batteries usagées  
Replacing the battery in the IR Remote  
Commander  
Use a commercially available CR2025 lithium  
battery. Do not use any battery other than a  
CR2025.  
conformément aux instructions du fabricant.  
VORSICHT  
1
Hold down the lock lever 1, pull out  
the battery holder 2, and remove the  
battery.  
• Explosionsgefahr bei Verwendung falscher  
Batterien. Batterien nur durch den vom  
Hersteller empfohlenen oder einen  
gleichwertigen Typ ersetzen.  
• Verbrauchte Batterien entsprechend den  
Anweisungen des Herstellers entsorgen.  
2
1
2
Place a new battery in the battery  
holder with the + symbol facing upward  
1, then push the battery holder into the  
IR Remote Commander until it clicks  
2.  
With the + symbol upward  
1
2
Using the IR Remote Commander  
29  
Handling SxS Memory  
Cards  
This camcorder records audio and video on SxS  
memory cards (optional) inserted in the card slots.  
• We recommend that you make a backup copy of  
important data. Sony accepts no responsibility  
for any damage or loss of data you recorded.  
• Do not apply a label sheet in places other than  
the label space. When applying the label sheet  
to this media, do not allow it to protrude from its  
proper location.  
About SxS Memory Cards  
Usable SxS memory cards  
Use the following Sony-made SxS memory cards  
(SxS PRO) with this camcorder:  
• SBP-8 (8GB)  
• SBP-16 (16GB)  
Operations are not guaranteed with memory cards  
other than SxS PRO.  
Label space  
These cards comply with the ExpressCard  
standard.  
• SxS memory cards to be used with this  
camcorder must be formatted using the format  
function of this camcorder. If a card is formatted  
using other device, it is regarded as of a  
different format, requiring repeated format  
operation on this camcorder.  
(Formatting or deleting with the function of the  
camcorder does not completely delete data on  
this media. When transferring or disposing of  
this media, use a commercial data deleting  
software or destroy the actual body at you own  
responsibility.)  
• SxS and SxS PRO are trademarks of Sony  
Corporation.  
• The ExpressCard word mark and logo are owned by  
Personal Computer Memory Card International  
Association (PCMCIA) and are licensed to Sony  
Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of  
their respective owners.  
Notes on using SxS memory cards  
• Recorded data may be damaged or lost in the  
following situations:  
• If the available recording time on a card is short,  
clip operation may be restricted. In such a case,  
delete unnecessary files by using a PC.  
• Remove or reinsert the case card with the case  
opened properly.  
—If you remove this media or turn off the  
power while formatting, reading or writing  
data.  
—If you use this media in locations subject to  
static electricity or electrical noise.  
• Do not use or store this media in the following  
locations:  
—Where recommended operating conditions  
are exceeded.  
—Inside a closed car in summer; or in strong  
sunshine / under direct sunlight / near a  
heater, etc.  
—Humid or corrosive location  
• Verify the correct direction of insertion before  
use.  
For write protection  
Setting the write-protect switch of the SxS  
memory card to “WP” disables you to record, edit  
or delete data.  
• When storing or carrying this media, put this  
media in the carrying case and lock it firmly.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
30  
             
Write-protect switch  
A
C
L
C
E
E
S
S
A
S
M
E
N
B
U
S
L
O
T
G
E
S
E
L
FUL
BAL  
E
C
T
C
H
-
1
CH-1  
AU  
L
SE  
xSPRO  
C
H
-2  
CH-2  
8
GB  
With the label  
Note  
facing right  
Do not operate the write-protect switch of an SxS  
memory card while it is set in the camcorder.  
Temporarily remove the card from the camcorder  
before changing the switch setting.  
The ACCESS lamp lights in red then changes  
to green once the memory card is ready for  
use.  
3
Close the cover.  
Inserting/Removing an SxS  
Memory Card  
Status indications by the ACCESS lamps  
Card slots A and B are accompanied by the  
respective ACCESS lamps to indicate their  
statuses.  
SLOT SELECT button  
Lamp  
Lights in  
red  
Slot statuses  
Accessing the loaded SxS memory card  
(writing/reading data)  
ACCESS lamps  
A
B
SLOT SELECT  
ACCESS  
Lights in  
green  
Standby (ready for recording or  
playback using the loaded SxS memory  
card)  
Card slots  
Off  
• No SxS memory card is loaded.  
• The loaded card is invalid.  
• An SxS memory card is loaded, but  
another slot is active.  
EJECT buttons  
OPEN  
Cover  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
Removing an SxS memory card  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
1
Open the cover, once press the EJECT  
button to release the lock, then pull the  
button out.  
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
N
D
X
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
E
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
A
C
L
C
E
S
S
A
SE  
M
E
N
B
U
S
L
O
T
G
E
S
E
L
FUL
BAL  
E
C
T
Inserting an SxS memory card  
C
H
-1  
CH-1  
AU  
SE  
L
C
H
-2  
CH-2  
O
P
E
N
1
2
Slide the cover to the left to open.  
Insert the SxS memory card into the  
slot.  
Press and unlock  
the button.  
2
Press the EJECT button again to  
remove the card.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
31  
             
memory card that is not formatted or that was  
formatted with another system, a message to  
confirm if formatting is to be executed is  
displayed on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
A
C
L
C
E
S
S
A
SE  
M
E
N
B
U
S
L
O
T
G
E
S
E
L
FUL
BAL  
E
C
T
C
H
-1  
CH-1  
AU  
L
SE  
C
H
-2  
CH-2  
O
P
Note on formatting  
Any SxS memory card formatted with a device  
other than this camcorder cannot be used with the  
camcorder.  
To execute formatting  
Notes  
If the message for formatting is displayed,  
turn the jog dial or tilt the joystick to select  
“Execute” then press the dial or joystick.  
• Data are not guaranteed if the power is turned  
off or a memory card is removed while the card  
is being accessed. All data on the card may be  
destroyed. Be sure that the ACCESS lamps are  
lit in green or off when you turn off the power  
or remove memory cards.  
• When you turn the camcorder on by setting the  
power switch to MEDIA (Media mode), a  
display to show that an SxS memory card is  
being confirmed appears on the LCD monitor/  
EVF screen.  
Formatting begins.  
The in-progress message and status bar (%) are  
displayed, and the ACCESS lamp lights in red.  
When formatting is completed, the completion  
message is displayed for three seconds.  
Recording/playback during formatting  
You can perform recording or playback using the  
SxS memory card in the other card slot while  
formatting is in progress.  
If formatting fails  
A write-protected SxS memory card or memory  
card that cannot be used with this camcorder will  
not be formatted.  
As a warning message is displayed, replace the  
card with an appropriate SxS memory card, as per  
the instructions in the message.  
The display automatically changes to the  
thumbnail screen (page 78) when a valid  
memory card is inside, but it remains on the  
screen if no valid memory card is loaded.  
To format by menu operation  
Switching Between SxS Memory  
Cards  
When no formatting message is displayed on the  
LCD monitor/EVF screen, you can execute  
formatting using “Format Media” (page 109) of  
the OTHERS menu in the same manner.  
When SxS memory cards are loaded in both card  
slots A and B, press the SLOT SELECT button to  
select the card you wish to use.  
If a card becomes full during recording, switching  
to the other card is automatically executed.  
Notes  
• All the data, including recorded pictures and  
setup files, are erased when a memory card is  
formatted.  
Note  
• SxS memory cards to be used with this  
camcorder must be formatted using the format  
function of this camcorder. Any card formatted  
with other device must be formatted again with  
this camcorder.  
The SLOT SELECT button is disabled while  
playback is in progress. Switching is not executed  
even if you press the button. The button is enabled  
on the thumbnail screen (page 78).  
Formatting an SxS Memory Card  
Formatting may be required before using an SxS  
memory card with this camcorder. For an SxS  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
32  
       
To restore a card  
Checking the Remaining Time  
Available for Recording  
Select “Execute” by turning the jog dial or  
tilting the joystick then push the dial or  
joystick.  
In Camera mode, you can check the time  
remaining for the SxS memory cards loaded in the  
card slots on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
The restore operation begins.  
During restoration, the in-progress message and  
status bar (%) are displayed, and the ACCESS  
lamp is lit in red.  
When restoration is completed, the completion  
message is displayed for three seconds.  
120min
A: 25min  
STBY  
T
B: 50min  
Z99  
If restoration fails  
The available time for recording with the current  
video format (recording bit rate) is calculated  
according to the remaining space of each card and  
displayed in time units of minutes.  
The remaining can also be checked in a meter  
format on the BATTERY/MEDIA status screen  
• A write-protected SxS memory card or one on  
which an error occurred cannot be restored. For  
such a card, a warning message is displayed.  
Release the write protection or replace the card,  
as per the instructions in the message.  
• An SxS memory card on which an error  
occurred may become usable again through  
repeated formatting.  
Note  
• In some cases, only parts of clips cannot be  
restored. Playback of the restored clips becomes  
possible again.  
A
icon appears if the memory card is write-  
protected.  
• The following operation may restore an SxS  
memory card for which the message “Could not  
Restore Some Clips” is repeatedly displayed  
each time you try the restoration process:  
Replacing an SxS memory card  
• If the available time on two cards in total  
becomes less than 5 minutes, a message “Media  
Near Full,” flashing of the tally lamps, and a  
beep sound will warn you. Replace the cards  
with those with sufficient space.  
• If you continue recording until the total  
remaining time reaches zero, the message  
changes to “Media Full,” and recording stops.  
1 Copy necessary clips to another SxS memory  
card, using the copy function (page 85) of the  
camcorder or the XDCAM EX Clip  
Browsing Software (page 113).  
2 Format the problem SxS memory card, using  
the format function of this camcorder.  
Note  
3 Return the necessary clips to the SxS  
memory card by copy operation.  
Approximately 600 clips can be recorded on one  
SxS memory card at maximum.  
Recording/playback during restoration  
You can perform recording or playback using the  
SxS memory card in the other card slot while  
restoration is in progress.  
If the number of recorded clips reaches the limit,  
the remaining time indication becomes “0,” and  
the message “Media Full” is displayed.  
Restoring an SxS Memory Card  
If an error occurs with data in a memory card for  
some reason, the card must be restored.  
If an SxS memory card that needs to be restored  
is loaded, a message that prompts you to execute  
a restore operation is displayed on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
33  
         
Recording  
Basic Operation Procedure  
Basic recording can be performed with the following procedures:  
REC START/STOP  
7,8  
LCD monitor  
4
L
E
C
N
A
C
L
O
V
REC REVIEW  
R
O
T
E
S
D
W
T
I
/
L
E
S
N
O
F
F
M
E
S
U
A
/
P
L
I
A
N
B
M
U
H
9
T
X
E
N
Y
A
L
P
/
T
V
E
P
O
T
S
R
F
P
O
T
S
/
T
V
E
R
C
E
P
R
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
5
T
R
S
H
N
S
IT  
A
O
T
IO  
B
G
N
N
LC  
D
B.  
LI  
2
.
HT  
O
TC  
UR -B  
IO  
D
/U  
IT  
N
1
O
A
T
/
FF  
8
S
T
A
D
B
A
T
TU  
IS  
P
LA  
S
T
Y
IN  
FO  
B
A
R
S
/C  
A
M
OFF  
MEDIA  
40  
L
E
N
S
IN  
CAMERA  
F
O
IRIS  
B
R
T
D
IS  
P
5
H
IS  
T
2
O
G
R
A
M
0
0
1
3
1
N
D
R
M
A
N
FIL  
U
A
SS  
IG  
TE  
2
I
A
A
F
D
U
N
F
E
T
O
O
M
3
5
1
M
A
C
A
5
RO  
R
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
A
IN  
C
C
D
O
1
5 . 8  
FF  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
IL  
F
M
E
O
Z
B
R
E
N
U
B
R
A
A
C
C
ES  
P
E
S
A
K
S
L
IN  
Power switch: CAMERA  
G
OT  
SE  
F
T
U
L
IN  
L
L
E
C
A
T
U
T
T
O
X
O
F
M
E
A
F
N
U
A
U
TO  
O
T
U
A
M
L
L
A
U
N
A
G
O
A
I
IN  
D
C
-1  
S
U
H
A
-1  
H
-EX1  
PMW  
C
C
N
W
I
L
M
H
HIT  
E
B
O
T
X
A
I
L
D
IN  
U
A
T
T
AU  
C
B
A
DIO  
E
E
E
L
E
L
EV  
O
T
N
P
L
U
A
R
A
M
S
T
A
U
2
-
C
H
H
-2  
O
P
E
N
Battery pack  
1
Lens cap OPEN  
3
FULL AUTO  
6
Memory card(s)  
2
When using the remote commander, activate the remote  
control mode (page 28).  
Preparations  
Note  
1
2
Mount a fully charged battery pack.  
Load SxS memory card(s).  
When you hold the camcorder by the grip,  
support it from underneath with your left hand.  
If you load two cards, recording is continued  
by automatically switching to the second  
card when the first card becomes full.  
3
4
Pull up on the lens cap open/close lever  
to open the lens cap built in the lens  
hood.  
Adjust the angle of the LCD monitor for  
the best view.  
When you wish to use the EVF, fold the LCD  
monitor to its park position and adjust the  
angle of the EVF.  
Recording (Full Auto mode)  
5
Set the power switch to the CAMERA  
position.  
6
Press the FULL AUTO button so that  
the button indicator lights.  
The camcorder is turned on and enters  
Camera mode.  
Basic Operation Procedure  
34  
               
Full Auto mode is turned on, activating the  
TLCS (Total Level Control System) (page  
101).  
REC  
START/STOP  
Thus Auto Iris, AGC (Auto Gain Control),  
Auto Shutter, ATW (Auto Tracing White)  
are set to ON, whereby the brightness and  
white balance will be automatically adjusted.  
HOLD  
REC HOLD lever  
To unlock the button, return the lever to its  
original position.  
When you wish to adjust them manually, turn Full  
Auto mode off, and see;  
Checking the last recorded clip (Rec  
Review)  
9
Press the REC REVIEW button.  
Note  
The Rec Review function (page 57) is  
activated, and the last recorded clip is played  
back for the specified time on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen.  
AF (Auto Focus) is not activated by setting  
the camcorder to Full Auto mode.  
For information of automatic focus adjustment,  
When playback reaches the end of the clip,  
the camcorder returns to STBY (recording  
standby) mode.  
7
8
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
You can start with either of the REC START/  
STOP button on the handle or that on the  
grip.  
(If you are using the IR Remote Commander, press  
the REC button simultaneously with the unmarked  
button.)  
To delete clips  
You can delete the last recorded clip by using the  
Last Clip DEL function.  
Use the All Clips DEL function when you wish to  
delete all recorded clips from a memory card.  
The front and rear tally lamps light and  
recording begins.  
To stop recording, press the REC  
START/STOP button again.  
(If you are using the IR Remote Commander, press  
the REC PAUSE button simultaneously with the  
unmarked button.)  
To specify a clip to be deleted, operate the  
camcorder in Media mode.  
Recording stops and the camcorder enters  
STBY (recording standby) mode.  
Note  
Recording cannot be restarted after you stop  
recording until the ACCESS lamp lights in green.  
To prevent a switching error  
The REC START/STOP button on the handle is  
incorporated with the REC HOLD lever. If the  
REC START/STOP button on the handle will not  
be used, it is recommended to set the lever to the  
HOLD position to lock the button.  
Basic Operation Procedure  
35  
             
L
Clip (recording data) and clip name  
When you stop recording, video, audio and  
subsidiary data from the start to end of the  
recording are recorded as a single clip on an  
SxS memory card.  
Selecting the Video  
Format  
For each clip recorded with this camcorder, a  
clip name of 8 characters (the first four  
alphanumerics and the second four numerics) is  
automatically generated.  
You can select various video formats for  
recording/playback using “Video Format” (page  
109) of the OTHERS menu.  
The current format is displayed on the screen  
when you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button.  
Example: ABCD0001  
The first four alphanumerics can be specified as  
desired using “Clip” (page 109) of the  
OTHERS menu before you start recording. (It  
cannot be changed after recording.)  
The second four-digit number is automatically  
counted up in sequence.  
T
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
1080/60i  
H
Q
S&Q Motion  
29/24fps  
Notes on Clips  
The XDCAM EX-series products employ the  
Selectable Formats  
FAT32 File System.  
The selectable formats depend on whether  
“Country” (page 109) of the OTHERS menu is  
set to “NTSC Area” or “PAL Area.”  
Thus, recorded materials may be segmented in  
multiple files depending on the file size. But the  
camcorder can play such materials seemlessly.  
A long clip can be recorded crossing over two  
memory cards in slot A and B.  
When you copy clips to a hard disk drive, etc.  
using a computer, it is recommended to use the  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software on the  
supplied CD-ROM.  
The video formats set on this camcorder cover the  
recording bit rate (HQ/SP), recording picture size  
(effective resolution), recording frame rate, and  
recording scan system (i/P).  
The frame rates are indicated with two-digit  
integers, rounding off the fractional part.  
Note  
When you select an HQ format, recording is made  
with the bit rate of 35 Mbps VBR.  
When you select an SP format, recording is made  
with the HDV-compatible bit rate of 25 Mbps  
CBR.  
If copying is done using Explorer (Windows)  
or Finder (MAC), the continuity and  
relationships of recorded materials may not be  
maintained.  
With “NTSC Area” selected  
Format  
Indication on this  
camcorder  
HQ 1920 × 1080  
59.94 interlace  
SP 1440 × 1080  
59.94 interlace  
HQ 1920 × 1080  
29.97 Progressive  
HQ 1080/60i  
SP 1080/60i  
HQ 1080/30P  
HQ 1080/24P  
SP 1080/24P  
HQ 720/60P  
HQ 1920 × 1080  
23.98 Progressive  
SP 1440 × 1080  
23.98 Progressive  
HQ 1280 × 720  
59.94 Progressive  
Selecting the Video Format  
36  
           
Format  
Indication on this  
camcorder  
Switching the ND Filters  
HQ 1280 × 720  
29.97 Progressive  
HQ 1280 × 720  
23.98 Progressive  
HQ 720/30P  
HQ 720/24P  
ND filters are available for keeping the aperture  
in a proper range.  
With “PAL Area” selected  
Set the ND filter switch according to the  
brightness of the subject.  
Format  
Indication on this  
camcorder  
HQ 1920 × 1080  
50 interlace  
HQ 1080/50i  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
SP 1440 × 1080  
50 interlace  
SP 1080/50i  
HQ 1080/25P  
HQ 720/50P  
HQ 720/25P  
O
SE  
E
S
M
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
HQ 1920 × 1080  
25 Progressive  
HQ 1280 × 720  
50 Progressive  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TRA SHO  
ITI  
NS  
T
ON  
B
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
M
4
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
2
AM  
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
U
EL  
T
A
S
FOCU  
P
I
C
F
I
L
M
EN  
O
S
ZE  
B
S
S
P
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
1
X
N
DIO  
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
T
L
DIO  
IN  
E
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LEC  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
HQ 1280 × 720  
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
25 Progressive  
ND  
FILTER  
2
1
Changing the Format  
ND filter switch  
OFF  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, display the OTHERS menu with  
, and set “Video Format.”  
1
2: / ND  
64  
1
1: / ND  
8
OFF: Clear  
O
THERS  
Bat tery  
Di rect  
i. LINK I/  
Tr i gger  
ountry  
Video For  
l i p  
B
I
NFO  
HQ 1080/60i  
SP 1080/60i  
HQ 1080/30P  
HQ 1080/24P  
SP 1080/24P  
HQ 720/60P  
HQ 720/30P  
The ND filter number is displayed on the screen  
when you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button.  
M
enu  
:
:
:
:
:
B
O
ode  
M
00:00  
C
m
at  
TLCS  
.
C
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
Note  
Signals from the COMPONENT OUT, SDI  
OUT, and A/V OUT connectors are also output  
according to the format selected with this menu.  
No indication is obtained if the ND filter switch is  
set to OFF.  
Note on recording format in SP 1080/24P mode  
When recording in SP 1440 × 1080 mode at 23.98  
in Progressive mode (indicated as SP 1080/24P  
on this camcorder), pictures are recorded at 59.94  
in Interlace mode (indicated as SP 1080/60i) by  
pull-down processing.  
Switching the ND Filters  
37  
         
WHITE BAL switch  
Adjusting the White  
Balance  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
L
M
H
B
A
PRST  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
FW  
F
I
N
L
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
The white balance must be adjusted to suit to the  
color temperature of the light source.  
You can select the adjustment mode according to  
the shooting conditions.  
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
4
M
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
A
O
ER  
2
AM  
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
8
.
C
IN  
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
O
E
N
L/SE  
R
E
U
S
T
A
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
IL  
F
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
LL  
LEC  
I
NT  
EX  
AU  
TO  
T
T
MAN  
U
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
IO  
D
LE  
IN  
E
T
P
Preset mode  
L
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
The color temperature is adjusted to the preset  
value (factory setting: 3200K) in this mode.  
Select this mode when there is no time to adjust  
the white balance or when you wish to fix the  
white balance to the condition of you set for a  
Picture Profile.  
B: ATW or Memory B mode  
A: Memory A mode  
PRST: Preset mode  
• Setting the camcorder to Full Auto mode (page  
34) forcibly activates ATW mode.  
• Assigning the ATW on/off function to an  
assignable button permits you to independently  
activate/deactivate ATW when Full Auto mode  
is off.  
Memory A mode, Memory B mode  
• The white balance is adjusted to the value stored  
in memory A or memory B.  
• Pressing the WHT BAL button executes auto  
white balance and stores the adjusted value in  
memory A or memory B.  
For details on the assignable buttons, see “Changing  
ATW (Auto-Tracing White balance) mode  
Using the Direct menu  
In this mode, the camcorder automatically adjusts  
the white balance to the appropriate condition.  
When the color temperature of the light source  
changes, the white balance adjustment is  
automatically executed.  
Five steps of adjustment speed can be selected  
with “ATW Speed” (page 101) of the CAMERA  
SET menu.  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button, the current adjustment mode and color  
temperature are displayed on the screen.  
TLCS  
.
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
ATW: ATW mode  
Selecting the Adjustment Mode  
Using the switch  
W:A: Memory A mode  
W:B: Memory B mode  
W:P: Preset mode  
You can select Preset mode, Memory A mode, or  
ATW (Memory B) mode with the WHITE BAL  
switch.  
To the B position of the WHITE BAL switch,  
ATW mode is assigned at the factory. The setting  
can be changed with “White Switch <B>” (page  
101) of the CAMERA SET menu to select  
Memory B mode.  
When the Direct menu is in All mode, you can  
select from among ATW, W:A, W:B, and W:P.  
When the Direct menu is in Part mode, you can  
switch between ATW and the mode set with the  
WHITE BAL switch.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Adjusting the White Balance  
38  
                 
completion message, and the obtained color  
temperature is displayed.  
Executing Auto White Balance  
• When you execute the adjustment in a memory  
mode, the adjusted value is stored in memory  
(A or B) selected in step 1.  
• When you execute the adjustment in ATW  
mode, adjustment in ATW is resumed.  
Execute auto white-balance adjustment according  
to the color temperature of the light source.  
The adjustment value can be stored in memory A  
or B.  
Note  
If auto white-balance adjustment fails  
An error message is displayed on the screen for  
approximately three seconds.  
Auto white-balance adjustment cannot be  
executed in Preset mode.  
If the error message is displayed, try auto white-  
balance adjustment again.  
If the error message continues to be displayed  
after several attempts, consult your Sony service  
representative.  
1
To store the adjustment value in  
memory, select Memory A or Memory  
B mode.  
2
3
Select the appropriate ND filter  
according to the lighting condition.  
Place a white subject under the same  
lighting condition and zoom in on it so  
that a white area is obtained on the  
screen.  
A white object (white cloth, a white wall,  
etc.) near the subject may be used in place.  
Be careful not to have any spots of high  
illumination on the screen.  
4
5
Adjust the lens iris opening.  
Set it to the proper condition if the manual  
iris adjustment mode is selected.  
Press the WHT BAL button.  
Auto white-balance adjustment begins.  
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
E
O
L
V
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
T
P
S
/
A
L
B
N
A
L
Y
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
/ S  
E
U
I L  
T
C
E
N
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
/ S  
I T  
F
E
O
R
F
T
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
N
B
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
C
-
R U D  
/
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
O
B
I
T
I
H
T
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
AU  
D
IO  
IN  
CH  
-2  
S
MIC  
O
T
T
E
S
R
L
IN  
P
A
R
E
/
T
MI  
C+  
48  
V
MI  
C
LIN  
E
E
L
R
V E  
C
B
R
S A  
MIC  
+
48V  
A
LE  
T
E
E
I
R
T
W
E
E
R
E
Y
E
F
A
C
O
X E  
P
S
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
SD  
I
O
U
T
A/  
V
O
UT  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
OFF ON  
WHT BAL button  
ASSIGN  
4
During adjustment, an in-progress message is  
displayed on the screen. When the adjustment is  
completed successfully, the message changes to a  
Adjusting the White Balance  
39  
     
Example: 95%  
120min  
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
Displaying the Markers  
and Zebra Patterns  
During recording, various markers and zebra  
patterns can be inserted into the image on the  
LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
This does not affect recording signals.  
When the aspect marker is on, the safety zone  
marker shows the effective area within the aspect  
marker.  
Displaying the Markers  
Displaying the center marker  
Use “Marker” of the LCD/VF SET menu.  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, display the LCD/VF SET menu with  
, and select “Marker” from the menu.  
Set “Center Marker” to “On” to insert the center  
marker into the screen area.  
120min  
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
LCD/VF SET  
Return  
LCD  
EVF  
Return  
Set t i ng  
Safet y Zone  
B
B
B
B
B
B
:
:
O
O
n
n
Peaking  
Safet y Area  
: 90%  
:
:
00:00  
Marker  
Center  
Aspect  
M
M
arker  
arker  
On  
Zebra  
Display  
On  
O
n/  
O
f f  
Aspect Select  
: 4 : 3  
Displaying the aspect marker  
Set “Aspect Marker” to “On” to insert the aspect  
marker into the screen area.  
Select the width of the marker from among 4:3,  
13:9, 14:9, and 15:9 with “Aspect Select.”  
Activating the marker indications  
• Set “Setting” to “On” then turn the markers on/  
off independently.  
No marker is displayed when “Setting” is “Off.”  
• Assigning the Marker on/off function to one of  
the assignable buttons permits you to operate  
“Setting: On/Off” by pressing the button.  
Example: 4:3  
120min  
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
For the assignable buttons, see “Changing  
Displaying the safety-zone marker  
Set “Safety Zone” to “On” to insert the safety-  
zone marker to the screen.  
With “Safety Area” you can select the size of the  
safety-zone marker from among 80%, 90%,  
92.5%, and 95% of the picture area.  
Displaying the guide frame lines  
Set “Guide Frame” to “On” to insert the guide  
frame lines into the screen area.  
120min  
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
Displaying the Markers and Zebra Patterns  
40  
                 
1 (Zebra1): To display a zebra pattern in the area  
of 10% centering the video level set with  
“Zebra1 Level.”  
2 (Zebra2): To display a zebra pattern for the  
video level over 100%.  
Displaying the Zebra Patterns  
A zebra pattern(s) can be inserted to the picture  
on LCD monitor/EVF screen to check the  
appropriate luminance level.  
Both: To display both Zebra1 and Zebra2  
Factory-set zebras  
Zebra1 Level  
Set the center level of Zebra1 in the range of 50 to  
1 (70%)  
2 (100%)  
107%. The default setting is 70%.  
Turning the zebra-pattern indication on/  
off  
Pressing the ZEBRA button turns the zebra  
pattern-indication on/off.  
ZEBRA button  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
L
M
H
B
A
PRST  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
N
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
1
X
N
DIO  
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
T
L
DIO  
IN  
E
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Changing the zebra pattern  
Using “Zebra” of the LCD/VF SET menu, you  
can change the zebra pattern to be displayed.  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, display the LCD/VF SET menu with  
, and select “Zebra” from the menu.  
LCD/VF SET  
Return  
B
LCD  
B
EVF  
B
Peaking  
00:00  
B
Marker  
Return  
B
B
Zebra  
Display  
Zebra Select : 1  
Zebra1 Level : 70  
On/Of f  
Zebra Select  
Select the zebra pattern(s) to be displayed.  
Displaying the Markers and Zebra Patterns  
41  
             
To change  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, display the CAMERA SET menu  
Setting the Gain  
with  
, and select “Gain Setup” from the  
menu.  
C
AMERA SET  
You can set the gain of the video amplifier  
according to the brightness of the subject.  
Select the setting mode required by the shooting  
conditions.  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shu t ter  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
Return  
Low  
Mid  
B
B
B
B
:
:
:
0dB  
9dB  
18dB  
S
lo  
w
S
hutter  
High  
00:00  
A
: Of f  
Fixed gain mode (manual gain  
adjustment)  
B
T
ype : Mul t i  
Select the gain of the video amplifier, using the  
switch or a menu operation.  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
AGC mode (automatic gain control)  
Selecting gain using the Direct menu  
The gain of the video amplifier is automatically  
adjusted according to the picture brightness.  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button, the current gain value is displayed on the  
screen.  
Recording With Fixed Gain  
TLCS  
.
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
Selecting the gain with the switch  
Select the gain, using the GAIN switch.  
Note  
When the Direct menu is in All mode, you can  
change the gain in steps of 3 dB with the Direct  
menu by operating the joystick or the jog dial.  
You can also select AGC mode with the Direct  
menu.  
When AGC mode is on, the fixed gain cannot be  
selected.  
When the Direct menu is in Part mode, you can  
switch between AGC and the gain selected with  
the GAIN switch.  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
GAIN switch  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
L
M
H
B
A
PRST  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
Note  
I
L
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
When the camcorder is in Full Auto mode (page  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
34), the Direct menu cannot be selected.  
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
N
/S  
R
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
U
AL  
U
N
A
M
1
X
G
AI  
N
DIO  
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Recording in AGC Mode  
When you set the camcorder to Full Auto mode  
(page 34), AGC mode is forcibly selected.  
When Full Auto mode is off, you can  
independently turn AGC mode on by setting  
“AGC” to “On” with “TLCS” (page 101) of the  
CAMERA SET menu or selecting AGC with the  
Direct menu.  
The gain value at each of the switch positions are  
set at the factory are as follows:  
L: 0 dB  
M: 9 dB  
H: 18 dB  
These values can be changed in the range of  
–3 dB to +18 dB, using the CAMERA SET menu.  
Setting the Gain  
42  
                   
shutter speed you specified with “Shutter” of the  
CAMERA SET menu.  
Setting the Electronic  
Shutter  
Note  
When Auto Shutter mode is ON, the fixed shutter  
cannot be selected.  
The electronic shutter of the camcorder permits  
you to change the shutter speed (the accumulation  
time per recording frame).  
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
The electronic shutter can be adjusted  
automatically or manually as required.  
O
E
V
L
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
A
T
L
P
S
/
Y
A
L
B
N
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
/ S  
E
U
L I  
T
C
E
N
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
/ S  
T
I O  
F
E
T
F
W
R
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
N
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
B
-
R U D  
/
C
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
B
I
T
I
H
T
O
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
AU  
DI  
O
IN  
CH  
-2  
S
MIC  
O
T
T
E
S
R
L
IN  
P
A
R
E
/
T
MI  
C+  
48  
V
MI  
C
LIN  
E
E
L
R
V E  
C
B
R
S A  
MIC  
+
48V  
A
LE  
T
E
E
I
R
T
W
E
E
R
E
Y
E
F
A
C
O
X E  
P
S
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
Fixed Shutter (manual adjustment)  
modes  
SD  
I
O
U
T
A/  
V
O
UT  
Recording is made with a specified shutter speed  
(accumulation time).  
Standard modes (Speed mode/Angle mode)  
These modes may be especially effective when  
you wish to record a quick-moving subject with  
little blurring.  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
OFF ON  
ASSIGN  
4
SHUTTER switch  
You can select Speed mode or Angle mode. In  
Angle mode, you can specify the shutter speed by  
setting the shutter angle.  
Setting the fixed shutter with the  
CAMERA SET menu  
ECS (Extended Clear Scan) mode  
Specify the shutter speed by frequency. This  
mode may be used to shoot the monitor screen  
eliminating horizontal bands.  
The shutter mode and shutter speed can be set  
with the CAMERA SET menu.  
Press the MENU button to set the camcorder to  
Menu mode, display the CAMERA SET menu  
SLS (Slow Shutter) mode  
with  
, and select “Shutter.”  
For shooting a subject in low-level lighting  
conditions. Specify the shutter speed in the  
number of accumulated frames.  
CA  
MERA SET  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shu t ter  
Return  
ode  
Shu t ter Speed: 1/125  
Shu t ter Angle : 180  
ECS Frequency : 60.02  
B
B
B
B
M
:
Speed  
EX Slow Shutter mode  
O
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
S
hutter  
00:00  
This is an advanced mode of SLS mode. The  
shutter speed is specified in the number of  
accumulated frames. Up to 64 frames can be  
accumulated in this mode, permitting you to  
obtain low-noise clear pictures in low light levels  
or a surreal pictures with afterimages.  
A
: Of f  
ype : Mul t i  
SLS Frame  
: 2  
B
T
Speed (standard speed) mode  
Set “Mode” to “Speed,” and specify the time ([ 1/  
setting value ] sec.) with “Shutter Speed.”  
The available setting values vary depending on  
the current frame rate.  
Auto Shutter mode  
The shutter speed is automatically adjusted  
according to the picture brightness.  
Frame rate Shutter speed (sec.)  
1
1
1
1
1
1
60i, 60P  
50i, 50P  
/
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
60, 100 125 250 500 1000  
1
/
2000  
Shooting in a Fixed Shutter Mode  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
24P  
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
32 48 50 60 96 125 250  
1
1
/
,
/
,
/
When you set the SHUTTER switch to ON, the  
fixed shutter is turned on in the mode and with the  
500 1000 2000  
Setting the Electronic Shutter  
43  
                               
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Frame rate Shutter speed (sec.)  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
25P  
/
/
/
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
,
33 50 60 100 125 250 500  
1
1
,
/
1000 2000  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
30P  
Shooting in EX Slow Shutter Mode  
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
40 50 60 120 125 250 500  
1
,
/
1000 2000  
Select “EX Slow Shutter” from the CAMERA  
SET menu.  
Angle (standard angle) mode  
Set “Mode” to “Angle,” and specify the shutter  
angle with “Shutter Angle.”  
C
A
M
E
R
A
SET  
Return  
B
B
B
B
:
Gain Setup  
Shu t ter  
You can select from among 180, 90, 45, 22.5, and  
11.25 degrees.  
Return  
Set t ing  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
S
hutter  
:
Of f  
00:00  
Number of  
Frames : 16  
ECS (Extended Clear Scan) mode  
Set “Mode” to “ECS,” and specify the frequency  
with “ECS Frequency.”  
A
Of f  
Mul t i  
B
T
ype  
:
The available setting values vary depending on  
the current frame rate.  
Set “Setting” to “On,” and specify the number of  
accumulated frames with “Number of Frames.”  
You can select from among 16, 32, and 64 frames.  
SLS (Slow Shutter) mode  
Set “Mode” to “SLS,” and specify the number of  
accumulated frames with “SLS Frame.”  
You can select in the range of 2 to 8 frames.  
Notes  
• EX Slow Shutter cannot be used in SP 1080/24P  
mode or Slow & Quick Motion mode.  
• The SHUTTER switch has no effect on the EX  
Slow Shutter setting.  
• The EX Slow Shutter On/Off setting cannot be  
changed during recording.  
Note  
Slow Shutter cannot be used in SP 1080/24P  
mode or Slow & Quick Motion mode.  
• You cannot set the camcorder to Full Auto  
mode (page 34) when the EX Slow Shutter  
mode is set to “On.”  
Setting with the Direct menu  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button, the current shutter mode and the set value  
are displayed.  
Shooting in Auto Shutter Mode  
When you set the camcorder to Full Auto mode  
(page 34), Auto Shutter is forcibly selected.  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
ND  
1
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000CH1  
CH2  
++  
When Full Auto mode is off, you can  
When the Direct menu is in All mode, you can  
change the shutter mode and speed with the  
Direct menu by operating the joystick or the jog  
dial.  
independently turn Auto Shutter mode on by  
setting “Auto Shutter” to “On” with “TLCS”  
(page 101) of the CAMERA SET menu.  
Notes  
• When the Direct menu is in Part mode, you  
cannot turn the shutter on/off with the Direct  
menu if the SHUTTER switch is set to ON.  
If the SHUTTER switch is set to OFF, only  
switching between Auto Shutter and Shutter  
OFF.  
• The Direct menu cannot be selected when the  
camcorder is in Full Auto mode (page 34) or  
when the EX Slow Shutter mode is set to “On.”  
Setting the Electronic Shutter  
44  
       
To adjust the target level with the Direct menu  
The target level can also be selected using the  
Direct menu.  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button, the current setting is displayed on the  
screen.  
Adjusting the Iris  
Adjust the iris opening according to the  
brightness of the subject. You can adjust it  
manually or automatically.  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
ND  
1
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000CH1  
CH2  
++  
Auto Iris mode  
You can change the setting with the Direct menu  
by operating the joystick or the jog dial.  
The iris is automatically adjusted according to the  
brightness of the subject.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Manual Iris mode  
Adjust the iris opening using the iris ring or with  
a menu operation.  
Adjusting the Iris Manually  
Set the IRIS switch to MANU to adjust the iris  
manually.  
IRIS switch  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
Rotate the iris ring for the desired iris opening.  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
Iris ring  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
O
T
T
E
/S  
D
FW  
F
I
N
L
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
3
1
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
E
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Recording in Auto Iris Mode  
When the camcorder is in Full Auto mode (page  
34), Auto Iris mode is forcibly turned on.  
When Full Auto mode is off, you can turn it on by  
setting the IRIS switch to AUTO.  
You can select the target level (to make the  
picture brighter or darker) of the Auto Iris control.  
(The gain control in AGC mode and the shutter  
speed control in Auto Shutter mode are adjusted  
in synchronization.)  
To adjust the target level with the Setup menu  
Set “Level” of “TLCS” (page 101) of the  
CAMERA SET menu.  
Adjusting the Iris  
45  
                     
Adjusting the Zoom  
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
E
O
L
V
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
A
T
L
P
S
/
Y
A
L
B
N
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
/ S  
E
U
I L  
T
C
E
N
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
/ S  
I T  
F
E
T
O
R
F
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
N
B
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
C
-
R U D  
/
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
O
B
I
T
I
H
T
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
AU  
DI  
O
IN  
CH  
-2  
S
MI  
O
T
S
L
IN  
E
C
P
A
T
R
/
T
MI  
C+  
48  
V
MI  
C
LIN  
R
E
E
E
L
R
B
R
S
A
V E  
M
IC  
A
LE  
T
E
E
I
+
48V  
T
W
E
C
R
E
R
E
Y
E
O
F
E
P X  
A
C
S
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
You can adjust the zoom in Manual mode or  
Power (Servo) mode on this camcorder.  
SD  
I
O
U
T
A/  
V
O
UT  
Manual Zoom mode  
ZOOM  
MANU SERVO  
Rotate the zoom ring to adjust the zoom.  
ZOOM switch  
Power Zoom (Servo) mode  
You can adjust the zoom by pressing the power  
zoom lever or zoom button on the handle.  
The supplied IR Remote Commander and  
optional lens remote control unit can also be used.  
Operating the Zoom Manually  
Setting the ZOOM switch to the MANU position  
for Manual Zoom mode activates the zoom ring.  
Rotate the zoom ring to adjust the zoom.  
The current zoom position is displayed on the  
screen in the range of 0 (Wide) to 99 (Tele) when  
you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO button.  
120min STBY  
A: 25min  
STBY  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
B: 50min  
Z99  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
The numerical indication can be changed to that  
in a bar by changing the “Zoom Position” setting  
of “Display On/Off” (page 105) of the LCD/VF  
SET menu.  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
Zoom ring  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
O
T
D
I
/S  
L
FW  
F
N
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
120min STBY  
A: 25min  
STBY  
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
V
E
R
E
R
B: 50min  
W
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
T
/CA  
0
4
M
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
 0
C
EL  
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
N
L/S  
U
SE  
IC  
T
A
FOCUS  
P
P
F
ILE  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Switching the Zoom Mode  
ZOOM  
MANU SERVO  
Switching between Manual mode and Servo  
mode is performed with the ZOOM switch  
located on the bottom of the camcorder.  
ZOOM switch:  
MANU  
Using the Power Zoom  
Setting the ZOOM switch to the SERVO position  
for Servo mode activates the power zoom.  
In Servo mode, the power zoom lever on the grip  
and the ZOOM button on the handle are activated.  
Adjusting the Zoom  
46  
                             
Zoom speed switch  
ZOOM button  
When adjusting with the ZOOM button of  
the IR Remote Commander  
Power zoom lever  
REC  
The zooming speed depends on the “Remote”  
setting (default: 50) of “Zoom Speed” of the  
CAMERA SET menu.  
START/STOP  
HOLD  
To use the IR Remote Commander, see “Using the IR  
H
L
OFF  
When using a lens remote controller  
Zooming can also be controlled from an optional  
lens remote controller connected via the LENS  
REMOTE connector.  
O
F
F
L
H
l
P
j
R
E
F
H
V
R
O
E
V
L
s
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
A
T
L
P
S
/
Y
A
L
B
N
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
/ S  
E
U
I L  
T
C
E
N
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
F
E
S
/
O
R
T
I
F
T
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
N
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
B
-
R U D  
/
C
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
I
B
T
I
H
T
O
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
AU  
DI  
O
IN  
CH  
-2  
For operation of the optional lens remote controller,  
refer to the operation guide of the lens remote  
controller.  
S
MIC  
O
T
S
L
INE  
P
A
T
R
/
T
MI  
C+  
48  
V
MI  
C
LIN  
R
E
E
E
L
B
R
S A  
E
R
R
E
C
MIC  
+
48V  
A
LE  
T
E
V
T
E
I
E
W
R
E
Y
E
A
O
F
E
P X  
S
C
U
A
S
N
D
E
D
SD  
I
O
U
T
A/  
V
O
UT  
ZOOM  
MANU SERVO  
ZOOM switch:  
SERVO  
To adjust with the power zoom lever on  
the grip  
Press the W (wide) side for a wider angle or the T  
(telephoto) side for a closer angle.  
Pressing the lever deeper sets zooming faster.  
To adjust with the ZOOM button on the  
handle  
Press the W side for a wider angle or the T side for  
a closer angle.  
Zooming is activated at the speed selected with  
the speed switch.  
The zoom speed assignment can be changed with  
the CAMERA SET menu.  
Speed  
switch  
H
ZOOM button operation  
Zoom changes with the speed set by  
“High” of “Zoom Speed” of CAMERA  
SET menu. (Default: 70)  
L
Zoom changes with the speed set by  
“Low” of “Zoom Speed” of CAMERA  
SET menu. (Default: 30)  
OFF  
Disabled  
Adjusting the Zoom  
47  
         
Adjusting the Focus  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
M
4
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
You can select any of three modes for focus  
adjustments.  
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
RA  
E
O
E
M
2
1
CA  
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
ET  
O
R
N
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
FILE  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
G
FU  
S
ELE  
C
T
LL  
IN  
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
EX  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
U
AL  
U
N
A
M
1
X
G
AI  
IO  
N
D
CH  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H-1  
S
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
IO  
IN  
E
T
L
D
U
E
AU  
A
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
H
CH  
-2  
C
O
PE  
N
Full MF (Full Manual Focus) mode  
Only adjustment with the focus ring is effective in  
this mode.  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
You can adjust the focus from to the minimum  
length by rotating the ring. The ring rotates  
endlessly in the both directions.  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OPEN  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
CLOSE  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
MF (Manual Focus) mode  
In this mode, auto focus can be temporarily  
activated by pushing the PUSH AF button.  
The MF Assist function can be used for  
assistance.  
Range index  
Focus ring: Rearward  
Rotate the focus ring for the best focus while  
observing the picture on the LCD monitor/EVF  
screen.  
AF (Auto Focus) mode  
The range index of the focus ring is effective in  
Full MF mode. The distances correspond to the  
focus ring positions.  
Auto focus functions continuously in this mode.  
The focus ring and the PUSH AF button can also  
be used.  
Note  
Expanded Focus  
The infinity position has some margin to  
compensate for focus change caused by variation  
in ambient temperature. When shooting an image  
at infinity in MF or Full MF mode, adjust the  
focus while observing the image on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen.  
When you press the EXPANDED FOCUS  
button, the center area of the picture is magnified  
on the LCD monitor/EVF screen, making the  
focus adjustment easier.  
Press the EXPANDED FOCUS button again to  
resume the normal angle for recording.  
Adjusting in Full MF Mode  
S
T
S
O
T
P
A
R
T
/
R E L E A S E  
R
E
V
E
I
R
W
E
C
F
E
X
O
C
P
U
A
N
S
D
E
D
Pull the focus ring rearward (toward the  
camcorder body) to set the camcorder to Full MF  
mode. Focus can only be adjusted with the focus  
ring manually.  
EXPANDED  
FOCUS  
button  
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
E
O
L
V
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
A
T
L
P
S
/
Y
A
L
B
N
R
/
Note  
T
R
P
A
S
/
E
N
U
A
L I  
T
C
E
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
E
P
T
X
L
N
F
E
S
/
O
R
T
I
F
T
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
N
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
B
-
R U D  
/
C
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
O
The focus instantly moves to the range index  
position when you pull the focus ring rearward.  
B
I
T
H
I
S
N
T
A
R
T
S
A
CH-  
1
AU  
D
IO  
IN  
CH  
-2  
S
MI  
C
O
T
T
S
L
IN  
E
P
A
R
/
T
MI  
C+  
4
8V  
M
IC  
LIN  
R
E
E
E
L
R
A
M
IC  
B
R
S
V E  
C
A
LE  
T
E
E
I
+
48V  
T
W
E
R
E
R
E
Y
F
A
N
D
O
E
P X  
A
U C  
S
S
E
E
D
SD  
I
O
U
T
A/  
V
O
UT  
Adjusting the Focus  
48  
                       
Peaking  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
FW  
F
I
N
L
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
When you press the PEAKING button, the  
peaking function is activated. This function  
emphasizes the contours of the images on the  
LCD monitor/EVF screen, making manual  
focusing easier.  
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
/
S
P
R
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
F
E
O
M
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
RA  
O
E
M
2
1
CA  
0
CEL  
3
N
1
A
IN  
8
.
C
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
ET  
O
RE  
FILE  
N
L/S  
U
A
SE  
T
FOCUS  
PIC  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
P
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MAN  
U
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
D
1
N
X
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
This function does not affect recording signals.  
The emphasis level and color of the contours can  
be set with “Peaking” (page 104) of the LCD/VF  
SET menu.  
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
T
L
DIO  
IN  
E
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
AF/MF  
Full MF  
PEAKING button  
IRIS  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OPEN  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
CLOSE  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
L
M
H
B
A
PRST  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
Focus ring: Forward PUSH AF  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
button  
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
FOCUS switch: MANU  
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
N
R
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
F
ILE  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Adjusting the focus with the focus ring  
Rotate the focus ring for the best focus while  
observing the picture on the LCD monitor/EVF  
screen.  
The range index of the ring is invalid in MF  
mode.  
Adjusting in MF Mode  
Slide the focus ring forward (toward the lens  
hood) and set the FOCUS switch to MANU to set  
the camcorder to MF mode. In this mode, you can  
activate Auto Focus only when required.  
One-Push (Momentary) Auto Focusing  
Push the PUSH AF button. Auto focusing  
momentarily activates (One-Push Auto  
Focusing).  
One-Push Auto Focusing is terminated when the  
subject comes in focus.  
MF Assist function  
When you stop rotating the focus ring with the  
MF Assist function active, auto focusing starts,  
performing fine focus adjustment for the subject  
in the center of the screen. When the fine  
adjustment is completed, automatic focusing with  
the MF Assist function is terminated.  
Activating the MF Assist function using the  
CAMERA SET menu  
Set “MF Assist” (page 99) of the CAMERA SET  
menu to “On.”  
Adjusting the Focus  
49  
                 
Activating the MF Assist function using the Direct  
menu  
The current focus adjustment mode is displayed  
on the screen when you press the DISPLAY/  
BATT INFO button.  
Using Macro Mode  
When you set the MACRO switch to ON in AF or  
MF mode, Macro mode is activated, permitting  
you to adjust the focus in a range that includes the  
micro area.  
TLCS  
.
7
On  
The Macro mode is invalid in Full MF mode.  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
In MF mode, you can activate/deactivate the MF  
Assist function with the Direct menu by operating  
the joystick or jog dial.  
When the function is active, an asterisk mark is  
displayed to the right of the mode indication.  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OPEN  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
CLOSE  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
MACRO switch  
Note  
The Direct menu cannot be selected in a mode  
other than MF mode.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Adjusting in AF Mode  
Slide the focus ring forward (toward the lens  
hood) and set the FOCUS switch to AUTO to set  
the camcorder to AF mode. In this mode, focus is  
always adjusted automatically.  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
IRIS  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OPEN  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
CLOSE  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
Focus ring: Forward  
FOCUS switch:  
AUTO  
The range index of the ring is invalid in AF mode.  
Focusing in AF mode  
In AF mode the camcorder continuously checks  
changes of images and activates auto focusing  
each time it detects a change. The auto focus  
adjustment is terminated when the subject comes  
into focus, and the camcorder stands by until the  
next change is detected.  
In AF mode, auto focusing is also activated when  
you press the PUSH AF button or operate the  
focus ring.  
Adjusting the Focus  
50  
             
Eliminating Picture  
Blurring (Steady Shot)  
Reducing Flickers  
By activating the Steady Shot function, blurring  
of images due to camera shaking can be reduced.  
To reduce flickers, try either of the following two  
methods:  
Setting with the CAMERA SET menu  
Setting the shutter speed according to  
the power-supply frequency  
Set “Steady Shot” (page 102) of the CAMERA  
SET menu to “On.”  
Activate the electronic shutter (page 43) and set  
the shutter speed according to the power supply  
frequency.  
Setting with the Direct menu  
When the frequency is 50 Hz  
When you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button, the setting of the Steady Shot function is  
displayed on the screen.  
1
1
Set the shutter speed to  
/
or /  
seconds.  
seconds.  
50  
100  
120  
When the frequency is 60 Hz  
1
1
Set the shutter speed to  
/
or /  
60  
TLCS  
.
7
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
F
Using the Flicker-Reduction function  
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PPOFF ND  
1
Set “Flicker Reduce” (page 99) of the CAMERA  
SET menu to “Auto” or “On” and set  
“Frequency” to the power-supply frequency (50  
Hz or 60 Hz).  
You can turn it on/off with the Direct menu by  
operating the joystick or the jog dial.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Note  
If the frame rate selected for recording is close to  
the power-supply frequency, flicker may not be  
reduced sufficiently even if you activate the  
Flicker-Reduction function. In such cases, use the  
electronic shutter.  
Note on use of a wide-conversion lens  
Two operation modes are provided for Steady  
Shot: Normal mode and Wide mode (for a wide  
conversion lens).  
When you attach the optional VCL-EX0877 wide  
conversion lens, be sure to set “Wide  
Conversion” (page 101) of the CAMERA SET  
menu to “On.”  
Note  
If the camcorder is fixed to a tripod for stable  
condition, deactivate the Steady Shot function.  
Eliminating Picture Blurring (Steady Shot) / Reducing Flickers  
51  
               
Setting the Timecode  
Setting the Time Data  
Specify the timecode to be recorded with  
“Timecode” and “TC Format” of the TC/UB SET  
menu.  
Time data, such as the timecodes, user bits, and  
the clock time, are recorded with pictures.  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
TC/UB SET  
Return  
Ti ecode  
sers B i t  
Return  
ode  
un  
Running Modes of the Timecode  
B
B
m
M
R
: Preset  
: Rec Run  
U
For the timecode, three running modes and Clock  
mode can be selected.  
TC For  
mat : DF Set t i ng : 00:00:00:00  
00:00  
R
eset  
Rec Run mode  
The timecode advances during recording only.  
The continuity of the timecode is maintained  
between clips in the sequence of recording as long  
as the SxS memory card is not changed.  
If you remove the memory card and record on  
another card, the timecode will not continue when  
you return the first card to the slot again.  
Setting the timecode to a desired value  
1
2
Set “Mode” of “Timecode” to “Preset.”  
Specify the timecode value on the  
Setting line and select “SET.”  
Resetting the timecode  
Free Run mode  
You can reset the timecode to be recorded in  
running modes to “00:00:00:00.”  
The timecode keeps advancing regardless of  
recording.  
1
2
Select “Reset” of “Timecode.”  
Select “Execute.”  
Regen mode  
The timecode advances during recording only.  
When you insert another memory card, the  
camcorder starts next recording so that the  
timecode continues to the last recorded timecode  
on the card.  
Using the actual time as the timecode  
Set “Mode” of “Time Code” to “Clock.”  
The time of the built-in clock is recorded as the  
timecode.  
Clock mode  
The current clock time is recorded for the  
timecode.  
Switching between DF and NDF of the  
timecode  
Note  
Using “TC Format” of the TC/UB SET menu, DF  
(drop-frame mode) and NDF (non-drop frame  
mode) of the timecode can be switched.  
Note, however, that the mode is fixed either to DF  
or NDF regardless of the TC Format setting,  
depending on the current frame-rate setting.  
In Interval Recording, Frame Recording, Slow &  
Quick Motion Recording, the timecode advances  
in Rec Run mode regardless of the “Run” setting  
if you set “Mode” of “Timecode” to “Preset.”  
If you set it to “Clock,” the timecode advances in  
Regen mode.  
Restrictions on the timecode  
The timecode setting is restricted by the current  
video format.  
Setting the Time Data  
52  
                   
Video  
formats  
Frame  
setting  
TC Format  
TC/UB SET  
Return  
B
B
Ti  
m
ecode  
Return  
ode : Fix  
HQ1080/60i 00 to 29  
SP 1080/60i  
HQ1080/30P  
DF/NDF switchable  
(Fixed to DF in Clock  
mode)  
U
sers B i t  
M
TC Format : DF Set t i ng : 20 07 12 08  
00:00  
HQ 1080/50i 00 to 24  
SP 1080/50i  
Fixed to NDF  
HQ 1080/25P  
1)  
3)  
2)  
HQ 1080/24P  
HQ 720/24P  
00 to 23  
00 to 29  
Fixed to NDF  
Setting eight digits as desired  
SP 1080/24P  
DF/NDF switchable  
(Fixed to DF in Clock  
mode)  
1
2
Set “Mode” of “Users Bit” to “Fix.”  
Specify the values on the Setting line  
and select “SET.”  
HQ 720/60P 00 to 29  
DF/NDF switchable  
(double count) (Fixed to DF in Clock  
mode)  
You can set hexadecimal digits A to F with  
the corresponding alphabetics.  
HQ 720/50P 00 to 24  
(double count)  
HQ 720/30P 00 to 29  
Fixed to NDF  
DF/NDF switchable  
(Fixed to DF in Clock  
mode)  
Recording the current date as the user  
bits  
HQ 720/25P 00 to 24  
Fixed to NDF  
Set “Mode” of “Users Bit” to “Date.”  
1)The frame digits in “Setting” are limited to 00, 04, 08,  
12, 16, and 20.  
The current date is displayed on the Setting line.  
The frame at the beginning of recording is limited to  
00, 04, 08, 12, 16, and 20.  
The frame digits of the timecode added to the SDI  
OUT connector output are changed to values in the  
range of 00 to 29.  
2)Even in Clock mode, the timecode may be gradually  
shifted, because it is counted by NDF.  
When adding the timecode to the output from the  
COMPONENT OUT connector or the video output  
from the A/V OUT connector, there may be a field that  
has dual timecodes because of the 2-3 pull-down  
process.  
Displaying the Time Data  
In Camera mode, pressing the DISPLAY/BATT  
INFO button displays the time data on the screen.  
T
REC  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
1080/24P  
H
Q
The indication is switched among the timecode,  
user bits, and recording duration each time you  
press the TC/U-BIT/DURATION button.  
3)With DF, the frame digits can be set as desired in the  
range of 00 to 29.  
With NDF, the frame at the beginning of recording is  
limited to 00, 05, 10, 15, 20, and 25.  
Display  
Contents  
TCG **:**:**:** Tmecode  
CLK **:**:**:** Timecode (Clock mode)  
UBG ** ** ** ** User bits  
Setting the User Bits  
DUR **:**:**  
Duration from the beginning of  
recording  
You can add a hexadecimal number of 8 digits for  
pictures as the user bits.  
The user bits can also be set to the current date.  
Use “Users Bit” of the TC/UB SET menu.  
Setting the Time Data  
53  
         
Using the Built-in Stereo  
Microphones  
Recording Audio Signals  
Set the AUDIO IN switches, both CH-1 and  
CH-2, to INT.  
Two channels (CH-1/CH-2) of audio can be  
recorded (Linear PCM recording) in  
synchronization with video recording.  
You can use the built-in stereo microphones  
(omni-directional electret condenser  
microphones) or 2-channel external audio inputs  
to the AUDIO IN connectors by switching with  
the AUDIO IN switches.  
Using External Inputs  
1
2
3
Set the AUDIO IN switches CH-1 and  
CH-2 to EXT.  
Connect external audio sources to the  
AUDIO IN connectors CH-1 and CH-2.  
Set the LINE/MIC/+48V switches CH-1  
and CH-2 to LINE (line level: +4 dBu).  
AUDIO IN  
connectors:  
AUDIO IN  
CH-1  
CH-2  
To input external  
sources  
Using an External Microphone  
MIC  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC+48V LINE  
MIC+48V  
LINE/MIC/+48V  
switches:  
To select the type of  
external source  
You can use an external microphone for  
recording, such as the ECM-673 Electret  
Condenser Microphone.  
Built-in stereo microphones  
1
Loosen the screw of the microphone  
holder and open the cover.  
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
E
O
L
V
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
T
P
S
/
A
L
B
N
A
L
Y
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
S
/
E
N
U
L I  
T
C
E
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
/ S  
T
I
F
E
O
R
F
T
W
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
O
F
L
Y
A
N
I
T
T
S
U
P S  
A B  
T
A
I
D
T
S
O
F
N
B
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
C
-
R U D  
F
L
/
T
T
H
N
O
H
G
I
L .  
B
D C  
L
N
O
O
B
I
T
H
I
T
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
l
AU  
DI  
O
IN  
P
R
E
j
F
H
O
V
R
E
CH  
L
s
-2  
D
V
T
H
U
S
G
S
T
P L A  
M
O
/
S
L
P
B
N
Y
/ P  
A
S
MI  
/
A
U
I
L
O
T
T
S
L
C
P
A
IN  
T
N
E
R
E
J
S
E
/
T
O
S
M
O
MI  
C+  
48  
P
T
X
E
L
N
V
MI  
/
S
I
T
O
C
F
LIN  
E
T
R
E
F
E
R
E
L
R
W
A
M
IC  
+
48V  
V
B
E
E S  
V E  
C
D
A
LE  
T
I
O
T
W
E
E
R
E
C
A
N
L
R
R
Y
S
A
C
O
F
X E  
P
E
S
U
N
A
C
E
D
E
D
L
F
F
O
SD  
I
O
U
T
T
T
H
G
I
A/  
L .  
V
B
O
UT  
D
C
L
B
S H
C
H
-2  
S
M
IC  
T
S
O
T
LI  
N
A
P
E
R
T
/
M
IC  
+
4
8
V
M
IC  
L
IN  
R
P
E
E
R
E
L
E
A
V
M
IC  
I E  
R
S
E
W
E
+4  
8
C
V
F
E
X
O
C
U
A
S
N
D
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
MENU  
2
Attach a microphone, close the  
microphone holder cover for the  
original condition to secure, then  
connect the microphone cable to either  
of the AUDIO IN connectors (CH-1 or  
CH-2).  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
INT  
EXT  
CH-1  
CH-1  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
AUDIO  
IN  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
INT  
EXT  
CH-2  
CH-2  
AUDIO IN switches:  
To select the source  
AUDIO SELECT switches:  
To select the recording level  
adjustment mode  
AUDIO LEVEL controls:  
To adjust the recording levels  
Recording Audio Signals  
54  
                               
1
O
F
F
L
H
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
l
P
R
E
H
O
V
2
T
S
H
U
O
T
M
T
S
/
B
N
A
CH1  
CH2  
R
T
/
L
I
S
/
S
T
C
O
E
M
O
P
X
T
N
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
F
S
T
I
E
O
R
F
T
W
ND1  
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
C
E
L
F F  
O
R
N
O
B
T
H
G
I
. L  
B
D
C
L
N
B
I O  
I T  
T
S
N
A
O
H
R
T
S
C
A
H
-1  
A
U
D
IO  
I
N
C
H
-2  
S T  
A R  
S
O P  
T /  
T
Audio recording in special recording  
modes  
M
IC  
+4  
8V  
M
IC  
LIN  
E
R
E V I E  
E L E A  
R E
M
IC  
+
48V  
S E  
to AUDIO IN  
4
• No audio recording is made in Interval  
Recording or Frame Recording.  
External  
microphone  
• No audio recording is made in Slow & Quick  
recording if the recording frame rate is set to a  
value different from the playback frame rate.  
Cable clamp  
3
Monitoring the Audio  
You can monitor the sounds being recorded with  
the headphones connected to the headphone  
connector (stereo mini jack).  
3
4
Set the corresponding AUDIO IN  
switch (CH-1 or CH-2) to EXT.  
Set the corresponding LINE/MIC/+48V  
switch (CH-1 or CH-2) according to the  
connected microphone.  
Headphone  
connector  
MONITOR VOL buttons  
MONITOR VOL  
MIC: For a microphone that requires no  
power supply  
HDV  
+48V: For a microphone that requires +48V  
power supply (such as the ECM-673)  
M
O
N
ITO  
T
R
H
U
V
O
M
B
L
N
A
IL  
S
E
L/S  
ET  
F
R
E
C
A
V
P
N
C
LA  
Y
EL  
j
/P  
AU  
S
E
P
F
F
W
D
R
E
/S  
V
S
J
l
TO  
P
s
N
E
X
T
L
S
TA  
R
E
T
C
/S  
TO  
R
P
H
H
O
L
O
L
F
D
F
-2  
CH  
IN  
O
DI  
A
U
-1  
CH  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
R
E
LE  
A
S
E
R
T
N
S
H
O
A
A
S
T
T
I
O
I
O
N
B
N
O
B
L .  
Adjusting the Audio Recording  
Levels  
F F  
H
G
I
T
T T A B  
D
I
F
N
I
Y
L
P S  
R U D  
B -  
C
T
O
A
I
/
T
A
T
I
U
/
S
R
A B  
N
O
M
A
C
/
U
T
A
T
S
S
S
E
L/  
S
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
FF  
R
A
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
-1  
-2  
P
IC  
TU  
P
R
A
M
U
AN  
TO  
R
E
O
FI  
UA  
LE  
L
I
D
C
NT  
T
AU  
IN  
DIO  
EX  
S
E
LE  
C
T
A
U
IN  
D
IO  
H
A
M
U
TO  
AN  
T
N
UA  
NE  
O
T
L
IN  
T
P
U
M
Y
C
O
EX  
A
TTER  
T
B
O
ASE  
T
U
RELE  
O
/V  
A
P
M
W
-E  
X
1
You can select automatic or manual adjustment  
mode independently for each channel.  
T
U
O
I
D
S
To adjust the levels automatically (AGC)  
Note  
When the AUDIO SELECT switches CH-1 and  
CH-2 are set to AUTO, the audio recording levels  
are automatically adjusted.  
The built-in speaker is disabled in Camera mode.  
To adjust the audio monitoring volume  
Use the MONITOR VOL buttons.  
Pressing the + button increases the volume, and  
pressing the – button decreases it. To muffle the  
sound, set it to the minimum level.  
While you adjust the volume, the level is  
displayed as a bar on the screen.  
To adjust the levels manually  
Set the AUDIO SELECT switches CH-1 and CH-  
2 to MANUAL, and adjust the audio recording  
levels by turning the AUDIO LEVEL controls.  
The value is set to 0 dB when the control is set to  
5. Setting to 10 maximizes the level (+12 dB) and  
setting to 0 minimizes it (–).  
The input levels are displayed on the screen when  
you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO button.  
Recording Audio Signals  
55  
               
Outputting the Color  
Bars and Reference  
Tone  
Recording Shot Marks  
When you record shot marks for important scenes  
as subsidiary data, you can access the marked  
points easily on a Shot Mark screen, which only  
displays scenes with shot marks only. This  
increases editing efficiency.  
The camcorder can output a color-bar signal in  
place of the camera picture.  
A 1-kHz reference tone is output with the color  
bar signal if “1kHz Tone” of “Audio Input” (page  
102) is set to “On” with the AUDIO SET menu.  
The color-bar signal and reference-tone signal are  
also fed out from the SDI OUT, COMPONENT  
OUT, and A/V OUT connectors.  
For the Shot Mark Screen, see “Displaying the  
The camcorder permits you to record two types of  
shot marks: shot mark 1 and shot mark 2.  
Shot marks can be recorded as needed during  
recording or can be added after recording while  
checking the playback pictures.  
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
LCD B.LIGHT  
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
BARS/CAM  
Inserting a shot mark during recording  
ON  
OFF  
Activate the IR Remote Commander (page 28),  
BARS/CAM button  
and use the SHOTMARK 1 or 2 button.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
V
C
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
PUSH SET  
E
R
1
SHOTMARK  
2
T
ZOOM  
W
SHOTMARK 1 button  
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
SHOTMARK 2 button  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
FIL  
N
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
THUMBNAIL SUB CLIP  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AUT  
O
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
-1  
H
-E  
W
C
C
W
IN  
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PR  
EL  
A
U
L
ST  
U
A
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
PREV  
PLAY/PAUSE  
NEXT  
STOP  
O
PE  
N
.
u
>
x
Press the SHOTMARK 1 or 2 button where  
you wish to insert a mark.  
Press the BARS/CAM button.  
The camera picture is switched to color bars.  
To return to the camera picture, press the button  
again.  
If the Shot Mark1 or Shot Mark2 function is  
assigned to an assignable button, you can also use  
it instead (page 57).  
You can select the type of color bars with “Color  
Bar Type” (page 99) of the CAMERA SET menu.  
Multi: ARIB multiformat color bars  
75%: Vertical stripes of 75% luminance  
100%: Vertical stripes of 100% luminance  
A shot mark of the type corresponding to the  
button you press is recorded.  
For operations to add shot marks after recording,  
Notes  
• When recording of the camera image is in  
progress, it cannot be switched to the color-bar  
picture even if you press the BARS/CAM  
button. (You can switch the color-bar picture to  
the camera picture.)  
• The color bar mode cannot be selected in Slow  
& Quick Motion mode and EX Slow Shutter  
mode.  
Outputting the Color Bars and Reference Tone / Recording Shot Marks  
56  
               
Rec Review  
Changing Functions of  
the Assignable Buttons  
You can review the last recorded clip on the  
screen (Rec Review).  
The camcorder has four assignable buttons to  
which you can assign various functions for  
convenience.  
S
T
O
S
T
P
A
R
T
/
ASSIGN 1 to 3 buttons  
R
E
L
R
E
E
A
V
S
E
I
E
W
R
E
C
F
O
E
X
C
U S  
P
A
N
D
E
D
REC REVIEW  
button  
LENS INFO BRT DISP HISTOGRAM  
ASSIGN  
1
2
3
O
F
F
L
H
l
s
P
j
R
F
H
V
E
R
E
O
L
V
D
T
S
G
U H  
S
O
T
P
M
T
P
S
/
A
L
B
N
A
L
Y
R
/
T
R
A
P
A
/ S  
E
U
I L  
T
C
E
N
J
S
M
O
O
E
S
P
T
X
E
L
N
/ S  
T
I
F
E
O
R
F
T
W
L
E
C
D
O
V
C
L
A
N
A
C
N
L
C
O
V
E
L
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
M
A
C
/
S
R
A B  
V
E
OP  
T
O
L
F
C
R
E
S
T/  
Y
A
N
I
T
P
R
S
U
P S  
T
D
A B  
R
A
T
A
I
T
S
T
S
N
B
O
F F  
O
/
T
I
I
T U  
A
C
-
R U D  
D
L
O
/
T
T
H
N
O
G
I
L .  
B
H
D C  
L
N
O
O
B
I
T
I
H
T
S
N
A
S
R
T
A
CH-  
1
AU  
H
D
IO  
L
F
F
IN  
O
CH  
-2  
S
M
IC  
O
T
S
L
IN  
E
P
A
T
R
/
T
MI  
C+  
48  
V
MIC  
LIN  
R
E
E
E
L
E
R
C
W
I
E
A
V
M
IC  
E
B
R
E
S
E
I
R
R
A
LE  
T
W
E
+
48V  
V
E
T
C
E
R
R
E
Y
F
A
N
D
O
E
P X  
A
U C  
S
S
E
E
D
A
T
R
S
H
A
N
O
T
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
SD  
RAM  
I
O
U
T
0
0
1
3
A/  
1
V
ND  
FIL  
O
UT  
M
A
N
A
SS  
IG  
U
TE  
2
IA  
AU  
R
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
U
EL  
T
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
F
ILE  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Press the REC REVIEW button after  
recording is finished.  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
OFF ON  
ASSIGN  
4
You can assign the Rec Review function to an  
ASSIGN 4 button  
assignable button to use it instead (page 57).  
The following functions are assigned at the  
factory:  
Playback of the specified block of the clip begins.  
In Rec Review, the last 3 seconds, 10 seconds, or  
the entire part of the clip is displayed, depending  
on the “Rec Review” setting (page 100) of the  
CAMERA SET menu. It is set to 3 seconds at the  
factory.  
ASSIGN 1 button (LENS INFO)  
Depth-of-field indication on/off  
ASSIGN 2 button (BRT DISP)  
Brightness-level indication on/off  
Rec Review is terminated at the end of the clip,  
resuming STBY (recording standby) status.  
ASSIGN 3 button (HISTOGRAM)  
Histogram indication on/off  
Notes  
ASSIGN 4 button  
No function is assigned (Off).  
• If the duration of the last recorded clip is less  
than the time (3 or 10 seconds) specified for Rec  
Review, the clip is played back from the  
beginning to the end.  
Changing Functions  
• During Rec Review playback, only the STOP  
button is valid.  
When the STOP button is pressed, Rec Review  
is canceled, and the camcorder returns to STBY  
(recording standby) status.  
Use “Assign Button” of the OTHERS menu.  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
1
Select “Assign Button” from the  
OTHERS menu.  
• If the video format is changed after recording,  
Rec Review cannot be performed.  
• The Setup and PICTURE PROFILE menus  
cannot be operated during Rec Review.  
Rec Review / Changing Functions of the Assignable Buttons  
57  
                     
O
THERS  
Al l Reset  
era Data  
e Zone  
Clock Set  
Language  
Assign But ton  
Tal l y  
Interval Recording  
B
C
Ti  
am  
m
Return  
:
B
UTC +09:00  
Engl i sh  
<1>  
<2>  
<3>  
<4>  
:
:
:
:
Freeze  
M
ark1  
ark 2  
ix  
00:00  
Shot  
Shot  
M
M
:
B
B
Rec Revie  
w
The Interval Recording (time-lapse recording)  
function is especially effective for shooting  
objects that move very slowly.  
The specified number of frames are automatically  
recorded at the specified intervals.  
2
3
Select the button to which you wish to  
assign a function.  
Select the function to be assigned.  
Recording interval (Interval Time)  
Function  
Contents  
Marker  
All marker indications (safety-  
zone marker, center marker,  
aspect marker, guide frames) on/  
off  
Last Clip DEL Last clip delete  
ATW  
ATW function on/off  
Rec Review  
Rec  
Rec Review start/stop  
Recording start/stop  
Freeze Mix  
Freeze Mix start/stop  
Expanded  
Focus  
Expanded Focus function on/off  
Number of frames for one recording session  
(Number of Frames)  
Spotlight  
Backlight  
TLCS Spotlight mode on/off  
TLCS Backlight mode on/off  
It is recommended to fix the camcorder to a tripod  
or equivalent and use the IR Remote Commander  
to start/stop recording rather than pressing the  
REC START/STOP button of the camcorder.  
IR Remote  
IR Remote Commander enable/  
disable  
Shot Mark1  
Shot Mark2  
Fader  
Shot mark 1 insert  
Shot mark 2 insert  
Notes  
Fader on/off  
EVF Mode  
EVF screen mode (color/  
monochrome) switching  
Brightness level indication on/off  
• Interval Recording cannot be set to “On”  
simultaneously with Frame Recording or Slow  
& Quick Motion. When you set Interval  
Recording to “On,” Frame Recording and Slow  
& Quick Motion are forcibly set to “Off.”  
• No audio recording is executed in Interval  
Recording.  
BRT Disp  
Histogram  
Lens Info  
Histogram indication on/off  
Depth-of-Field indication on/off  
4
Exit the menu.  
• Interval Recording cannot be performed if an  
SP video format is selected with “Video  
Format” and “i.LINK I/O” is set to “Enable”  
with the OTHERS menu.  
The assigned functions can be viewed on the  
BUTTON/REMOTE status screen (page 92).  
• Interval Recording cannot be performed if  
“Video Format” of the OTHERS menu is set to  
SP 1080/24P.  
Preparatory Settings  
Before starting Interval Recording, make the  
necessary settings on the CAMERA SET menu in  
advance.  
Interval Recording  
58  
                                       
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
• The Freeze Mix function and Rec Review  
function cannot be used in Interval Recording  
mode.  
• The timecode is recorded in Rec Run mode  
(page 52) during Interval Recording.  
• Some extra frames may be recorded if you stop  
recording or switch the card slot while  
recording is halted in Interval Recording mode.  
1
Select “Interval Rec” of the CAMERA  
SET menu.  
C
A
M
E
R
A
SET  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
olor ar Type  
F l i cker Reduce  
oo peed  
I n ter val Rec  
Fra e Rec  
B
A
:
Of f  
C
B
:
Mul t i  
B
B
B
B
Return  
Set t ing  
Interv al  
Stopping Interval Recording  
00:00  
Z
m
S
:
:
Of f  
1sec  
1
T
i
me  
m
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
m
Number of Fra  
es :  
Interval Recording stops.  
To restart Interval Recording, press the button  
again.  
2
Set “Setting” to “On.”  
The camcorder enters Interval Recording  
mode.  
When the special recording mode indication  
on the screen is active, “Interval Rec” flashes  
on the screen.  
Canceling Interval Recording mode  
Set “Setting” of “Interval Rec” of the CAMERA  
SET menu to “Off.”  
Note  
3
4
Set the time between recordings with  
“Interval Time.”  
It automatically returns to “Off” when you set the  
power switch to OFF, while the “Interval Time”  
and “Number of Frames” settings are maintained.  
You can select the time from among 1 to10/  
15/20/30/40/50 seconds, 1 to 10/15/20/30/  
40/50 minutes, and 1 to 4/6/12/24 hours by  
scrolling the display.  
Set the number of frames to be recorded  
at a time with “Number of Frames.”  
When “Video Format” (page 109) is set to  
“720/60P” or “720/50P,” you can select from  
among 2, 6, and 12 frames.  
With other settings, you can select from  
among 1, 3, 6, and 9 frames.  
5
Exit the menu.  
Performing Interval Recording  
When the preparatory settings are completed, you  
can start recording.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Interval Recording begins.  
The flashing “Interval Rec” on the screen is now  
steadily lit.  
Notes  
• You cannot change the “Interval Time” and  
“Number of Frames” settings while Interval  
Recording is in progress. To change them,  
pause recording.  
Interval Recording  
59  
 
The camcorder enters Frame Recording  
mode.  
When the special recording mode indication  
on the screen is active, “Frame Rec” flashes  
on the screen.  
Frame Recording  
3
4
Select the “Number of Frames” value  
for one recording session.  
The Frame Recording function is especially  
effective for clay animation recording.  
The specified number of frames are recorded  
intermittently when you press the REC START/  
STOP button.  
It is recommended to fix the camcorder to a tripod  
or equivalent and use the IR Remote Commander  
to start/stop recording rather than pressing the  
REC START/STOP button of the camcorder.  
You can select from among 2, 6, and 12 when  
“Video Format” is set to 720/60P or 720/50P.  
With other video formats, you can select  
from among 1, 3, 6, and 9.  
Exit the menu.  
Notes  
Performing Frame Recording  
• Frame Recording cannot be set to “On”  
simultaneously with Interval Recording or Slow  
& Quick Motion. When you set Frame  
Recording to “On,” Interval Recording and  
Slow & Quick Motion are forcibly set to “Off.”  
• No audio recording is executed in Frame  
Recording.  
• Frame Recording cannot be performed if an SP  
video format is selected with “Video Format”  
and “i.LINK I/O” is set to “Enable” with the  
OTHERS menu.  
When the preparatory settings are completed, you  
can start recording.  
1
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Recording in Frame Rec mode begins.  
The “Frame Rec” indication stops flashing.  
When the number of frames you specified  
with the menu are recorded, the camcorder  
automatically enters FRM STBY (Frame Rec  
Standby) status.  
• Frame Recording cannot be performed if  
“Video Format” of the OTHERS menu is set to  
SP 1080/24P.  
2
Press the REC START/STOP button  
again.  
Each time you press the REC START/STOP  
button, the camcorder records the specified  
number of frames then enters FRM STBY  
status.  
Preparatory Settings  
Before starting Frame Recording, make the  
necessary settings on the CAMERA SET menu in  
advance.  
Notes  
• Recording cannot be stopped until the specified  
number of frames are recorded. If the power  
switch is set to OFF during recording, the power  
is only shut off after the specified number of  
frames are recorded.  
• The Freeze Mix function and Rec Review  
function cannot be used while recording in  
Frame Rec mode is in progress.  
• You cannot change the “Number of Frames”  
setting while recording in Frame Rec mode is in  
progress. To change it, pause the recording.  
• The timecode is recorded in Rec Run mode  
(page 52) during Frame Recording.  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
1
Select “Frame Rec” of the CAMERA  
SET menu.  
C
MF  
C
A
M
A
E
R
A
SET  
ssis t  
olor ar Type  
F l i cker Reduce  
:
:
Of f  
Mul t i  
B
B
B
B
B
B
Z
oo  
I n ter val Rec  
Fra e Rec  
S&Q Mot i on  
m
Speed  
00:00  
Return  
Set ting  
m
:
Of f  
1
Nu  
mber of Fra  
m
es :  
• Some extra frames may be recorded if you stop  
recording or switch the card slot while  
recording is paused in Frame Rec mode.  
2
Set “Setting” to “On.”  
Frame Recording  
60  
       
Stopping Frame Recording  
Slow & Quick Motion  
Recording  
Set “Setting” of “Frame Rec” of the  
CAMERA SET menu to “Off.”  
Recording stops and Frame Rec mode is  
canceled.  
When an HQ Progressive (P) video format is  
selected (page 36), you can set the frame rate for  
recording different from that for playback.  
By recording at the different frame rate, you can  
obtain smoother slow-motion or quick-motion  
effect when compared with slow-speed or fast-  
speed playback of a material recorded at the  
normal recording speed.  
Note  
It automatically returns to “Off” when you set the  
power switch to OFF, while the “Number of  
Frames” setting is maintained.  
Example  
When the video format is HQ 720/24P, recording  
with a frame rate between 1 and 23 fps provides a  
quick-motion effect in playback, and recording  
with the frame rate between 25 and 60 fps  
provides a slow-motion effect in playback.  
Notes  
• Slow & Quick Motion cannot be set to “On”  
simultaneously with Frame Recording or  
Interval Recording. When you set Slow &  
Quick Motion to “On,” Frame Recording and  
Interval Recording are forcibly set to “Off.”  
• No audio recording is made if the recording  
frame rate is set to a value different from the  
playback frame rate.  
• Slow & Quick Motion recording cannot be  
made if “Video Format” of the OTHERS menu  
is set to HQ1080/60i, HQ1080/50i, SP1080/60i,  
SP1080/50i, or SP1080/24P.  
Preparatory Settings  
Before starting Slow & Quick Motion recording,  
make the necessary settings with the CAMERA  
SET menu in advance.  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
1
Select “S&Q Motion” from the  
CAMERA SET menu.  
Slow & Quick Motion Recording  
61  
       
Notes  
C
AMERA SET  
C
olor  
B
ar Type : Mul t i  
• You cannot change the Frame Rate setting  
while Slow & Quick Motion recording is in  
progress. To change it, pause the recording.  
• The timecode is recorded in Rec Run mode  
during Slow & Quick Motion recording (page  
52).  
B
F l i cker Reduce  
B
B
B
B
B
Z
oo  
I n ter val Rec  
Fra e Rec  
S&Q Mot i on  
ec eview  
m
Speed  
00:00  
m
Return  
Set t ing  
Frame Rate : 30  
: Of f  
R
R
2
3
4
Set “Setting” to “On.”  
Stopping recording  
The camcorder enters Slow & Quick Motion  
mode.  
When the special recording mode indication  
on the screen is active, “S&Q Motion” is  
displayed on the screen.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Slow & Quick Motion recording stops.  
Note  
When recording at a low-speed frame rate, it may  
take time until recording stops after you press the  
REC START/STOP button.  
Select the frame rate for recording with  
“Frame Rate.”  
The setting range varies depending on the  
current video format.  
With a 1080 format: 1 to 30 fps  
With a 720 format: 1 to 60 fps  
Canceling Slow & Quick Motion mode  
Set “Setting” of “S&Q Motion” of the CAMERA  
SET menu to “Off.”  
Note  
Exit the menu.  
It automatically returns to “Off” when you set the  
power switch to OFF, while the “Frame Rate”  
setting is maintained.  
Setting the recording frame rate with the  
Direct menu  
When the special recording mode indication on  
the screen is active, [Recording frame rate]/  
[Playback frame rate] fps is displayed under  
“S&Q Motion.”  
T
S&Q  
STBY  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
1080/24P  
H
Q
S&Q Motion  
29/24fps  
You can change the recording frame rate with the  
Direct menu by operating the joystick or the jog  
dial.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Recording in Slow & Quick Motion  
Mode  
When the preparatory settings are completed, you  
can start recording.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Slow & Quick Motion recording begins.  
Slow & Quick Motion Recording  
62  
   
• The Freeze Mix function cannot be used if the  
recording video format is SP 1080/24P.  
• The Freeze Mix display cannot be obtained in  
Quick & Slow Motion mode or Slow Shutter  
mode.  
• You cannot operate the Setup menus and  
PICTURE PROFILE menu in Freeze Mix  
status.  
Freeze Mix: Image  
Alignment  
Using the Freeze Mix function, an image (still  
picture) of a recorded clip can be temporarily  
superimposed on the current camera picture,  
permitting you to easily align images for next  
recording.  
To use the Freeze Mix function  
Assign the Freeze Mix function to one of the  
assignable buttons.  
Superimposing a Freeze Mix image  
1
2
Stop recording to set the camcorder to  
STBY (recording standby) status.  
Press the REC REVIEW button to  
review the recorded images, or press the  
ASSIGN button to which you assigned  
“Freeze Mix.”  
3
Press the ASSIGN button to which you  
assigned “Freeze Mix” at the image  
with which you want align.  
The image where you pressed the ASSIGN button  
in step 3 is displayed as a still picture over the  
current camera picture.  
Canceling Freeze Mix status  
You can cancel it with the ASSIGN button to  
which you assigned “Freeze Mix” or the REC  
START/STOP button.  
• When you cancel Freeze Mix status by pressing  
the ASSIGN button, the normal camera picture  
is restored.  
• When you cancel Freeze Mix status by pressing  
the REC START/STOP button, normal  
recording begins.  
Notes  
• If the recorded picture and the current camera  
picture differ in video format, the Freeze Mix  
display cannot be achieved.  
Freeze Mix: Image Alignment  
63  
   
A button  
B button  
Shot Transition  
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
LCD B.LIGHT  
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
BARS/CAM  
The Shot Transition function helps you to easily  
obtain complex picture effects by registering  
camera settings or conditions as a “shot” to be  
reproduced in a recording sequence.  
ON  
OFF  
MODEbuttonand  
indicator  
Your settings for focus, zoom, iris, gain, shutter  
speed, white balance, color matrix, and detail  
level can be registered in combination in one shot,  
and you can change the current camera settings to  
those of the shot, or the settings reproduced from  
one shot to those of another Shot, resulting in a  
smooth transition of scenes.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
I
L
A
U
A
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
V
E
R
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TI  
OF  
ON  
/
81.2  
F
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
4
M
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MAC  
5
RO  
R
A
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
ET  
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
U
EL  
T
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
-1  
A
U
E
-
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
For example, you can shift the focus from a closer  
object to a farther object, or change the depth of  
field by adjusting the iris. In addition, you can  
develop scenes under different recording  
conditions smoothly. If you register the manual  
adjustment function for white balance, the scenes  
will develop smoothly between objects indoors  
and those outdoors.  
O
PE  
N
A button and B button  
You can register a Shot to each of the buttons.  
MODE button and indicator  
When you press this button, the camcorder enters  
Shot Transition operation mode, and the indicator  
of the button lights.  
The shot transition operation area is displayed on  
the screen.  
Each time you press the button, the shot-transition  
operation mode cycles among Store, Check,  
Execute, and Off (normal Camera mode).  
In Execute mode, the shot transition information  
area appears.  
Notes  
• Shot transition cannot be activated in  
combination with any of the EX Slow Shutter,  
Interval Recording, Frame Recording, and Slow  
& Quick Motion functions.  
• If you wish to shift the focus in a shot transition,  
set the focus adjustment mode to MF or AF (see  
page 48). The focus will not be shifted if Full  
MF mode is selected.  
• If you wish to shift the zoom in a shot transition,  
set the ZOOM switch to SERVO (see page 46).  
The zoom will not be shifted with the MANU  
setting.  
• If you register a focus position in a macro area  
with the MACRO switch ON, the focus may not  
be shifted to the registered position if a shot  
transition is executed with the MACRO switch  
set to OFF.  
Shot-transition operation area  
RC  
TCG 00:00:00:00  
Shot Transition  
Execute  
Shot-  
Shot-  
A
B
S
E
0s  
Rec Link:  
12s  
ff  
Shot-transition operation buttons and  
indications  
O
Shot-transition information area  
For shot-transition operations, use the three  
TRANSITION operation buttons on the upper  
panel.  
Note  
Camera operations are disabled when the shot  
transition operation mode is Check or Execute.  
Shot Transition  
64  
       
When adjustments are required, set the mode to  
Store.  
Time/Speed  
Set whether to specify the duration of a  
transition by time or by speed of zoom  
transition.  
Preparatory Settings  
Setting Contents  
Time  
The “Transition Time” setting is valid.  
The “Transition Speed” setting is  
valid.  
Before you start recording using the Shot  
Transition function, make the necessary settings  
with the CAMERA SET menu in advance.  
The conditions you set are indicated in the shot  
transition information area on the screen when  
you set the shot-transition operation mode to  
“Execute.”  
Speed  
Trans Curve  
Select the transition pattern.  
The corresponding icon is displayed in the  
shot transition information area.  
Shot-transition information area  
Setting  
and icon  
Linear  
Contents  
Progress bar  
To make the transition linearly.  
S
E
12s  
ff  
Transition pattern  
Transition time  
P
0s  
Rec Link:  
O
T
Rec Link status  
Start timer indication  
Soft Trans  
To make the transition slowly at  
the beginning and end but linearly  
in between.  
Setting procedure  
P
1
Select “Shot Transition” from the  
CAMERA SET menu.  
T
C
A
M
E
R
A
SET  
Soft Stop  
To make the transition slowly near  
the end.  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shut ter  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
Return  
B
B
B
B
Trans Time  
Trans Speed  
Time/Speed  
Trans Curve  
St art Timer  
:
:
:
:
:
:
2sec  
5
Speed  
Soft Stop  
Of f  
S
lo  
w
S
hutter  
00:00  
A
:
:
Of f  
P
B
T
ype  
Mul t i Rec Link  
Of f  
2
Specify the conditions for a shot  
transition.  
T
P: Parameter level T: Transition of time  
Trans Time  
Start Timer  
Set the time from start of recording to start of  
the shot transition.  
The countdown indication is displayed in the  
shot-transition information area until the shot  
transition is started by the Start Timer.  
After you set “Time/Speed” to “Time,” set  
the duration of a transition in the range of 2  
to 15 sec in steps of 1 second.  
Trans Speed  
After you set “Time/Speed” to “Speed,” set  
the zoom transition speed (specifying the  
time to be taken for the zoom moving from  
the TELE end to the WIDE end at a certain  
speed).  
Rec Link  
Set whether to link shot-transition start and  
target shot selection to recording start.  
The setting status is displayed in the shot  
transition information area.  
The setting range is from 1 to 10. The larger  
the number you set, the higher speed.  
Shot Transition  
65  
 
Off: Not to link to recording start  
Making a transition from the current  
picture to a registered shot  
(To use the A or B button to start the  
transition and specify the target shot)  
Shot-A: To start the transition to Shot A in  
synchronization with recording start  
Shot-B: To start the transition to Shot B in  
synchronization with recording start  
1
Adjust the camera settings to obtain an  
image with which you wish to start  
recording.  
3
Exit the menu to finish the settings.  
2
Press the MODE button to display  
“Execute” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
Registering a shot  
You can register two kinds of shots: A and B.  
3
4
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Recording begins.  
1
Press the MODE button to display  
“Store” in the shot-transition operation  
area.  
When “Rec Link” is “Off,” press the  
button of the target shot (A or B) when  
you wish to start the shot transition.  
2
3
Adjust the camera settings to obtain an  
image you wish to register.  
The current camera settings are gradually  
shifted to those registered to the specified  
shot.  
When “Rec Link” is “Shot-A” or “Shot-  
B,” the camcorder automatically performs  
the shot transition to the camera settings  
registered to Shot A or Shot B, respectively.  
You need not press the button.  
When adjustment is finished, press the  
Shot A or Shot B button.  
The camera settings are registered to the pressed  
button.  
The registered camera settings are maintained  
until you register them next.  
Notes  
• You cannot return to the status in step 1 once  
after you start the shot transition. If the status  
must be resumed, register it as a shot.  
Checking the Registered Settings (Shot)  
1
Press the MODE button to display  
“Check” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
• When you perform recording on an external  
device connected via the i.LINK(HDV)  
connector in synchronization with REC  
START/STOP operations on this camcorder,  
recording start on the external device and shot-  
transition start may not be synchronized even if  
“Rec Link” has been set to “Shot-A” or “Shot-  
B,” depending on the performance of the  
external device.  
2
Press the A or B button, whichever you  
assigned to the shot you wish to check.  
The selected shot (camera settings or conditions)  
takes effect on the picture on the screen.  
With this operation, you cannot check the  
conditions of the transition.  
Making a transition from Shot A to Shot B  
When “Rec Link” is set to “Off” or “Shot-B,” a  
shot transition from Shot A to Shot B is possible.  
Recording with a Shot Transition  
1
Press the MODE button to display  
“Check” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
When the preparatory settings are completed, you  
can start recording.  
Operations differ depending the “Rec Link”  
setting.  
2
Press the A button.  
The picture is adjusted according to the  
camera settings registered for Shot A.  
Shot Transition  
66  
 
To cancel recording while a transition is in  
progress  
If you press the REC START/STOP button  
during recording, the recording stops, even when  
a shot transition is in progress.  
3
4
5
Press the MODE button to display  
“Execute” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
The E-E picture of the settings where the  
recording stops is displayed.  
Recording begins with the camera settings  
registered for Shot A.  
When “Rec Link” is “Off,” press the B  
button when you wish to start the shot  
transition.  
Releasing a Shot Transition  
Press the MODE button so that the button  
indicator goes dark.  
When “Rec Link” is “Shot-B,” the  
camcorder automatically performs the shot  
transition to the camera settings registered  
for Shot B. It is not necessary to press the B  
button.  
The LCD monitor/EVF screen resumes the  
normal condition.  
Making a transition from Shot B to Shot A  
When “Rec Link” is set to “Off” or “Shot-A,” a  
shot transition from Shot B to Shot A is possible.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press the MODE button to display  
“Check” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
Press the B button.  
The picture is adjusted according to the  
camera settings registered for Shot B.  
Press the MODE button to display  
“Execute” in the shot-transition  
operation area.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Recording begins with the camera settings  
registered for Shot B.  
When “Rec Link” is “Off,” press the A  
button when you wish to start the shot  
transition.  
When “Rec Link” is “Shot-A,” the  
camcorder automatically performs the shot  
transition to the camera settings registered  
for Shot A. It is not necessary to press the A  
button.  
Ending recording  
When recording is completed, press the REC  
START/STOP button.  
Shot Transition  
67  
Fade In  
Set this to “On” to start recording with fade  
in.  
(When you operate the function using an  
assignable button, it is not necessary to set  
“Fade In” to “On” with the menu.)  
Fader Function  
Using the Fader function, you can start a  
recording by fading in a scene or end a recording  
by fading out of a scene.  
The fader function can be assigned to an  
assignable button.  
Fade In Type  
Select the initial status of the fade-in.  
White: To fade in from a white screen  
Black: To fade in from a black screen  
Fade In Time  
Set the duration (1/2/3/5/10 sec.) of fade-in.  
For function assignment, see “Changing Functions  
Notes  
3
Specify the fade-out conditions.  
• The fader function cannot be used in  
combination with the Slow & Quick Motion,  
Interval Recording, Frame Recording, or EX  
Slow Shutter function.  
• When a clip is recorded using the fade-in  
function, a white or black screen becomes the  
index frame on the thumbnail screen (page 78).  
Change the index frame for easier  
Fade Out  
Set this to “On” to end recording with fade  
out.  
(When you operate the function using an  
assignable button, it is not necessary to set  
“Fade Out” to “On” with the menu.)  
Fade Out Type  
Select the final status of the fade-out.  
White: To fade out to a white screen  
Black: To fade out to a black screen  
identification.  
• When you perform recording on an external  
device connected via the i.LINK(HDV)  
connector in synchronization with REC  
START/STOP operations on this camcorder,  
recording start/stop on the external device and  
fade-in start/fade-out end may not be  
synchronized, depending on the performance of  
the external device.  
Fade Out Time  
Set the duration (1/2/3/5/10 sec.) of fade-out.  
4
Exit the menu.  
• If you set “Fade In” to “On” with the menu, the  
camcorder enters Fade-in standby status when  
you exit the menu.  
• When the Fader indication on the screen is  
active, the initial status (“White Fader” or  
“Black Fader”) you set with “Fade In Type”  
flashes.  
Preparatory Settings  
Specify the conditions to activate the Fader  
function in advance with the following  
procedure:  
74%  
1
Select “Fader” of the CAMERA SET  
menu.  
White Fader  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
C
A
M
m
E
R
A
SET  
Speed  
I n ter v al Rec  
Fra e Rec  
S&Q ot i on  
ND  
1
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000CH1  
CH2  
++  
B
B
B
B
Zoo  
Return  
Fade I n  
Fade I n Type  
Fade I n Ti  
:
:
:
:
Of f  
m
Black  
2sec  
Of f  
M
me  
When using an assignable button  
00:00  
Rec Review  
Fader  
TLCS  
:
B
2sec  
Fade  
Fade  
Fade  
O
O
O
ut  
ut Type : Black  
ut Ti e: 2sec  
If you assigned the Fader function to an  
assignable button, the Fade In/Fade Out On/Off  
settings can be made using the button.  
B
m
2
Specify the fade-in conditions.  
Fader Function  
68  
           
For fading in a scene  
Note  
Press the ASSIGN button to which you assigned  
the Fader function in STBY (recording standby)  
status.  
The Fade In/Fade Out settings automatically  
return to “Off” when you turn off the camcorder,  
while the Type and Time settings set with the  
menu are maintained.  
The fade-in function is turned on.  
For fading out  
Press the ASSIGN button to which you assigned  
the Fader function during recording.  
The camcorder enters in the fade-out standby  
status.  
Starting Recording with a Fade In  
When the preparatory settings are completed, you  
can start recording.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
Recording begins by fading in the camera picture.  
When the fade-in process you specified is  
completed, the camcorder enters Normal  
Recording mode.  
The Fade-In Type indication flashes during the  
fade-in process and goes off when the process  
ends.  
Ending Recording with a Fade Out  
• If you set “Fade Out” to “On” with the menu,  
the camcorder automatically enters Fade-out  
standby status when it is set to Recording mode.  
• When you press the ASSIGN button to which  
you assigned the Fader function after starting  
recording, the camcorder enters fade-out  
standby status.  
Press the REC START/STOP button to  
start fading out of the camera picture.  
The fading-out process begins.  
When the fading-out process you specified is  
completed, recording simultaneously stops.  
The Fade-Out Type indication flashes during the  
fade-out process and goes off when the process  
ends.  
Canceling the Fader function  
Set “Fade In” and “Fade Out” to “Off” with the  
menu.  
Or press the ASSIGN button again.  
Fader Function  
69  
       
P
I
CTURE PROFILE  
OFF  
SEL  
SET  
Picture Profiles  
PP1: STANDARD  
PP2: STANDARD  
PP3: STANDARD  
PP4: STANDARD  
PP5: STANDARD  
PP6: STANDARD  
You can customize the picture quality, depending  
on the conditions or circumstances of recording,  
and store them as a picture profile, enabling the  
picture quality to be resumed just by your  
selecting the picture profile.  
4
Operating the jog dial or the joystick,  
select “SET” and make the settings of  
the picture profile items.  
Six different picture profiles (PP1 to PP6) can be  
stored in memory.  
P
I
CTURE PROFILE  
The same standard (reference) values are  
registered to six picture profiles at the factory as  
those specified for the Picture Profile Off status.  
The PICTURE PROFILE menu is available for  
picture-profile operations.  
PP1: STANDARD  
Return  
SEL  
SET  
B
B
B
B
B
B
Pro f i le Na  
atrix  
Color Correction  
hi te  
Detail  
me  
M
W
Note  
The picture profiles can be operated only in  
Camera mode. They cannot be operated in Media  
mode.  
For details on the setting items, see “Picture  
5
When the settings are completed, press  
the PICTURE PROFILE button to exit  
the menu.  
Registering the Customized  
Settings as a Picture Profile  
Selecting a Picture Profile  
Power switch:  
CAMERA  
O
N
O
D
B
F
L .  
F
I
G
H
T
B
A
T
T
D
I
N
I
Y
P
S
Selecting a Picture Profile using the  
PICTURE PROFILE menu  
F
L
O
A
U
R
T
B
A
C
A
T
T
I
U
/
R
O
I
S
N
B -  
C
/
A
/
M
S
T
A
T
U
S
OFF  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
S
E
L
/S  
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
R
F
F
A
Once you store a picture profile, you can call the  
picture quality registered in the picture profile as  
follows:  
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
H
-
-
1
P
P
AU  
MANU  
IC  
O
T
F
T
U
IL  
O
R
E
E
R
AL  
D
C
INT  
EXT  
A
IN  
U
D
IO  
T
S
E
L
E
C
A
U
D
IO  
N
2
I
AU  
MANU  
T
O
AL  
PICTURE  
PROFILE  
INT  
EXT  
Y
T
TER  
BA  
E
AS  
LE  
RE  
P
M
W
-
E
X
1
1
Set the power switch to CAMERA to  
turn the camcorder on in Camera  
mode.  
PICTURE PROFILE  
button  
T
U
O
I
D
S
2
3
Press the PICTURE PROFILE button.  
1
Set the power switch to CAMERA to  
turn the camcorder on in Camera  
mode.  
The PICTURE PROFILE menu is displayed.  
Operating the jog dial or the joystick,  
select “SEL” then the desired picture  
profile from the list.  
2
3
Press the PICTURE PROFILE button.  
The PICTURE PROFILE menu is displayed.  
Operating the jog dial or the joystick,  
select “SEL” from the PICTURE  
PROFILE menu then select the picture  
profile number (PP1 to PP6) to operate.  
Picture Profiles  
70  
             
3
4
Specify the target picture profile.  
Example:  
“Execute” and “Cancel” are displayed.  
P
I
CTURE PROFILE  
OFF  
SEL  
SET  
Select “Execute.”  
PP1: SceneA  
PP2: SceneB  
PP3: SceneC  
PP4: SceneD  
PP5: SceneE  
PP6: SceneF  
Copying begins.  
When copying ends, the completion message is  
displayed for three seconds, and the original  
screen display is restored.  
The camcorder is adjusted to the picture  
quality specified by the selected Profile.  
(If you select “OFF,” the camcorder will be  
fixed at the standard picture quality, and no  
picture adjustment is allowed.)  
Resetting a Picture Profile  
You can reset a selected picture profile to the  
factory settings (standard status).  
4
Press the PICTURE PROFILE button  
to exit the menu.  
1
Select the picture profile you wish to  
reset by proceeding from step 1 to 3 of  
Selecting a Picture Profile using the  
Direct menu  
2
3
Select “Reset” from “SET” of the  
PICTURE PROFILE menu.  
The picture profile being selected is displayed  
when you press the DISPLAY/BATT INFO  
button.  
“Execute” and “Cancel” are displayed.  
Select “Execute.”  
TLCS  
.
Resetting begins.  
7
F
*
On  
1
1.5  
2
3
4
5
7
10 15 20 30  
oo  
m
M
++  
F1.9 18dB SHT:1/2000  
ATW 4300K PP  
1
ND1  
When resetting ends, the completion message is  
displayed for three seconds, and the original  
screen display is restored.  
You can select picture profiles with the Direct  
menu by operating the joystick or the jog dial.  
For details on the Direct menu, see “Direct Menu  
Copying the Settings of a Picture  
Profile  
You can copy the settings of a selected picture  
profile to another picture profile.  
1
Select the source picture profile by  
proceeding from step 1 to 3 of  
2
Select “Copy” from “SET” of the  
PICTURE PROFILE menu.  
The picture profile numbers are listed on the  
screen.  
Picture Profiles  
71  
     
Picture Profile Items  
The values when “Off” is selected at “SEL” of the PICTURE PROFILE menu are shown in bold face  
(example: Standard).  
PICTURE PROFILE SET  
Items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Profile name  
Set the profile name in 8 characters at maximum.  
Profile Name  
Changing the picture profile  
name  
You can use upper- and lowercase alphabetics,  
numerics 0 to 9, - (hyphen), _ (underscore) and  
space.  
Setting  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to activate the color phase adjustment  
function with matrix operations for the entire  
picture.  
Matrix  
Adjusting the color phase  
over the entire area with  
matrix operations  
Note  
When this function is set to “Off,” Color Correction  
is also set to “Off” in synchronization.  
Select  
Select the built-in preset matrix provided for  
convenience.  
Standard /High SAT / FL  
Light / Cinema  
Level  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the color saturation for the entire picture  
area.  
Phase  
Adjust the hue for the entire picture area.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
R-G, R-B, G-R, G-B, B-R, B-G  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Finely adjust the color phase for the entire picture  
area by independently setting each of the factors.  
Setting  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to enable the color phase adjustment  
for a specific area. (Simultaneous adjustment of  
multiple areas is not allowed. You can adjust it for  
one area only.)  
Color Correction  
Adjusting the color phase in  
a specific area  
1)  
Execute to detect the color in the center of the  
screen. The area centering around the detected  
color of the range specified by “Target Width”  
becomes the target area of Color Correction.  
Area Detection  
Execute/Cancel  
2)  
Set to “On” to display the Zebra 1 pattern for the  
target area of Color Correction.  
Area Indication  
On / Off  
Target Phase  
0 to 359 (130)  
Manually adjust the center color for the target area  
for Color Correction.  
Note  
When Area Detection is executed, this setting is  
overwritten by the Area Detection result. Perform  
fine adjustment with this item as required.  
Target Width  
0 to 90 (40)  
Set the width of color phase for the target area for  
Color Correction.  
Level  
Set the saturation for the color in the target area.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Phase  
Adjust the hue for the color in the target area.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Picture Profiles  
72  
           
PICTURE PROFILE SET  
Items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Offset White  
Set to “On” to shift the conversion value for auto  
White  
On / Off  
white balance in Memory A or B mode and that for  
auto tracing white in ATW mode to a lower color  
temperature or a higher color temperature.  
Setting the white balance  
offset and the color  
temperature of the preset  
white  
Offset<A>  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the volume of the offset white (shifting  
volumes) of the conversion value in Memory A,  
Memory B, or ATW mode, respectively.  
Offset<B>  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Offset<ATW>  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Preset White  
2100 to 10000 (3200)  
Adjust the preset color temperature when Preset  
white balance mode is selected in steps of 100K.  
Notes  
• Except when the white balance is in Memory A  
or B mode or when ATW is active, you cannot  
confirm the result of changing the Offset White  
and Offset settings on the screen.  
• Except when Preset white balance mode is  
selected, you cannot confirm the result of  
changing the Preset White settings on the screen.  
Setting  
Set to “On” to apply the details to the video signal.  
Detail  
On / Off  
Adjusting the details to be  
applied to the picture  
Level  
Adjust the detail level.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Frequency  
Set the center frequency of the details.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Setting the center frequency higher decreases the  
details, and setting it lower increases the details.  
Crispening  
Adjust the noise-suppression level.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
When you set it to a higher level, less noise may be  
seen, as fine elements of details are deleted leaving  
only high-level elements.  
When you set it to a lower level, fine elements are  
applied while increasing noise.  
H/V Ratio  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the horizontal-to-vertical ratio of detail  
elements.  
A higher value makes the vertical elements  
increased with respect to the horizontal elements.  
White Limiter  
Limit the white details.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Black Limiter  
Limit the black details.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
V DTL Creation  
NAM / Y / G / G+R  
Select the source signal to generate vertical details  
from among NAM (G or R whichever is higher), Y,  
G, and G+R.  
Knee APT Level  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the knee aperture level (level of details to be  
applied to the sections above the knee point).  
Picture Profiles  
73  
   
PICTURE PROFILE SET  
Items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Setting Set to “On” to enable the detail level adjustment for  
On / Off  
Skin Tone Detail  
Adjusting the details to be  
applied to the areas of a  
specific color phase  
specific color-phase areas.  
The detail level is uniform over the entire picture  
with the Off setting.  
Level  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the skin-tone detail level.  
1)  
Execute to detect the color in the center of the  
screen. The area centering around the detected  
color becomes the target area for Skin Tone Detail  
control.  
Area Detection  
Execute/Cancel  
2)  
Set to “On” to display the Zebra 1 pattern for the  
target area for Skin Tone Detail control.  
Area Indication  
On / Off  
Saturation  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the color (saturation) level for Skin Tone  
Detail control.  
Note  
When Area Detection is executed, this setting is  
automatically returned to 0.  
Phase  
0 to 359 (130)  
Adjust the center color-phase value for the target  
area for Skin Tone Detail control.  
Note  
When Area Detection is executed, this setting is  
automatically changed to the value equivalent to  
that of the detected color.  
Width  
0 to 90 (40)  
Adjust the width of the color phase of the target  
area for Skin Tone Detail control.  
Note  
When Area Detection is executed, the Width  
setting automatically returns to 40.  
Setting  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to compress the high-luminance area of  
the picture.  
Knee  
Adjusting the knee level  
Note  
Knee is fixed and cannot be changed in the  
following cases:  
• When Gamma is set to CINE1 to 4  
• When the electronic shutter is in SLS mode  
• When EX Slow Shutter is active  
Auto Knee  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to automatically set the best knee  
conditions according to the luminance level of the  
picture.  
With “Off” the knee conditions can be manually  
adjusted independently of the luminance level of  
the picture.  
Point  
Set the knee point when Auto Knee is “Off.”  
50 to 109 (90)  
Slope  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Set the knee slope (volume of compression) when  
Auto Knee is “Off.”  
Knee SAT Level  
0 to 99 (50)  
Adjust the knee saturation level for the area over  
the knee point.  
Picture Profiles  
74  
   
PICTURE PROFILE SET  
Items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Level Adjust the gamma compensation level.  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Gamma  
Adjusting the gamma  
compensation level and  
selecting the gamma curve  
3)  
Select the type of reference curve for gamma  
compensation.  
Select  
STD1 / STD2 / STD3 / STD4 /  
CINE1 / CINE2 / CINE3 /  
CINE4  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the master black level.  
Black  
Adjusting the black  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the level of black gamma function that  
emphasizes only the dark areas of the picture to  
clear the tones or on the contrary de-emphasizes it  
to reduce noise.  
Black Gamma  
Adjusting the black gamma  
level  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Adjust the level of the low key saturation to  
heighten the colors only in the dark areas of the  
picture or pale them to reduce noise.  
Low Key SAT  
Adjusting the low key  
saturation  
Execute / Cancel  
Execute / Cancel  
Select “Execute” to copy.  
Copy  
Copying a picture profile  
Select “Execute” to reset.  
Reset  
Resetting a picture profile  
1)To execute “Area Detection”  
3)Available gamma curves  
STD1: This deemphasizes the contrast in dark areas  
more than STD2 and emphasizes the contrast in  
intermediate areas.  
STD2: This deemphasizes the contrast in dark areas  
more than STD3.  
1. Select “Area Detection.”  
A square marker that indicates the detection  
area appears in the center of the screen, and  
“Execute” and “Cancel” are displayed below.  
STD3: Standard (factory setting)  
STD4: This emphasizes the contrast in dark areas more  
than STD3.  
CINE1:This smoothes the contrast in darker areas and  
accentuates gradation changes in brighter areas,  
for a calm and quiet effect.  
CINE2:This gives almost the same results as CINE1.  
Select this when you wish to obtain 100% video  
signals for editing or other purposes.  
CINE3:This emphasizes the contrast between light and  
dark more than CINE1 and CINE2, and also  
accentuates gradation changes on the black side.  
CINE4:This emphasizes the contrast in dark areas more  
than CINE3. Contrast in dark areas is weaker  
and contrast in bright areas is stronger than STD  
curves.  
2. Select “Execute.”  
Color-phase detection in the marker area is  
performed.  
When detection successfully ends, a  
completion message is displayed. Then the  
screen is restored, on which the target area  
for the Color Correction or Skin Tone Detail  
adjustment is changed to the area centering  
around the color detected by “Area  
Detection,” and the Area Indication (zebra  
pattern) appears.  
If detection fails, an error message appears,  
then the precious screen is restored.  
2)The Area Indication setting is common to all picture  
profiles PP1 to PP6.  
Picture Profiles  
75  
         
3
Select “Execute” again.  
The last recorded clip is deleted from the  
memory card.  
Deleting Clips  
For details on menu operations, see “Basic Menu  
In Camera mode, the Last Clip DEL function for  
deleting the last recorded clip and the All Clips  
DEL function for deleting all clips from a  
memory card are available.  
Deleting All Clips  
Using the Setup menu, you can delete all recorded  
clips from the memory card in the selected card  
slot.  
In Media mode, you can specify the clip to be  
deleted.  
1
2
3
Select “All Clips DEL” from “Clip” of  
the OTHERS menu.  
For clip deletion in Media mode, see “Deleting a  
Select “Execute.”  
Deleting the Last Recorded Clip  
The confirmation message is displayed.  
Using the assignable button to which you  
assigned the Last Clip DEL function or the Setup  
menu, the last recorded clip is easily deleted.  
Select “Execute” again.  
All the clips are deleted from the memory  
card.  
Note  
To delete using the assignable button  
Clips with the OK mark applied cannot be  
deleted.  
Assign the Last Clip DEL function to one of the  
assignable buttons (see page 57) in advance.  
For details on the OK mark, see “Adding the OK  
1
2
Press the assignable button to which  
you have assigned “Last Clip DEL.”  
The confirmation message is displayed.  
Operating the joystick or the jog dial,  
select “Execute.”  
The last recorded clip is deleted from the  
memory card.  
To delete using the Setup menu  
1
Select “Last Clip DEL” from “Clip” of  
the OTHERS menu.  
O
THERS  
Di rect  
i. LINK I/  
Tr i gger  
ountry  
Video For  
l i p  
For  
M
enu  
O
ode  
:
:
:
:
:
B
B
Part  
D
isable  
M
Both  
NTSC  
Return  
Ti t l e Pref i x  
C
:
:
234_  
0001  
00:00  
m
at  
HQ 1080/60i Number Reset  
C
Last  
A l l  
C
l i p DEL Execute  
m
at  
M
edia  
C
l i ps DEL Cancel  
2
Select “Execute.”  
The confirmation message is displayed.  
Deleting Clips  
76  
         
Notes  
• If a setup file already exists on the memory card  
you specified in Step 1, a message to confirm  
whether to overwrite the file is displayed.  
• If there is not sufficient space on the memory  
card, an error message is displayed.  
Storing/Retrieving the  
Setting Data  
You can store all the menu settings (including  
picture profiles) as a setup file on an SxS memory  
card.  
By retrieving the stored setup file, the proper  
setup condition can be immediately obtained.  
For the setup file operations, use “Camera Data”  
of the OTHERS menu.  
Retrieving the Setup File  
When you retrieve the stored setup file, the  
camcorder settings are changed according to the  
file.  
Note  
1
Insert the memory card on which you  
stored the setup file into a card slot.  
The Clock Set, Time Zone, Hours Meter (page  
108) values are excluded.  
Check that the corresponding memory card  
icon is displayed on the screen. If a memory  
card in the other slot is selected, press the  
SLOT SELECT button to switch.  
Storing the Setup File  
Only one setup file can be stored on one SxS  
memory card.  
2
3
4
Select “Camera Data” from the  
OTHERS menu.  
1
Insert a memory card on which you  
wish to store the setup file to a card slot.  
Select “Recall.”  
“Cancel” and “Execute” appear to the right.  
Check that the corresponding memory card  
icon is displayed on the screen. If a memory  
card in the other slot is selected, press the  
SLOT SELECT button to switch.  
Select “Execute.”  
Reading of data from the memory card  
begins.  
2
Select “Camera Data” from the  
OTHERS menu.  
An in-progress message is displayed during data  
reading. When the read-out is completed, a  
completion message is displayed, indicating that  
the camcorder settings have been changed  
according to the setup file.  
O
THERS  
Return  
B
B
Al l Reset  
Camera Data  
Return  
Store  
Time Zone  
Clock Set  
Language  
:
B
UTC +09:00  
Engl i sh  
Recall  
00:00  
Resetting to the Standard Values  
:
B
Assign Bu tton  
The current camcorder settings you made through  
various menu and button operations can be  
collectively returned to the standard statuses  
(factory settings) by executing “All Reset” of the  
OTHERS menu.  
3
4
Select “Store.”  
“Cancel” and “Execute” appear to the right.  
Select “Execute.”  
Writing of data to the memory card begins.  
An in-progress message is displayed during  
writing. When writing is completed, a completion  
message is displayed.  
Storing/Retrieving the Setting Data  
77  
                 
Playback  
Playing Back Clips  
Turning the camcorder on with the power switch  
set to MEDIA sets it to Media mode, and the clips  
recorded on the SxS memory card are displayed  
as thumbnails on the screen. (If no clips are  
recorded on the card, a no-clip message is  
displayed.)  
You can start playback from the clip selected on  
the thumbnail screen.  
The playback picture can be seen on the LCD  
monitor/EVF and external monitors.  
For connection of external monitors, see  
Thumbnail Screen  
Clip index frame  
The index frame images of the clips on the SxS  
memory card are displayed as thumbnails.  
The recording date and starting time are displayed  
below the index image of each clip. (The OK  
mark symbol is displayed if the clip is marked.)  
The first frame is automatically specified as the  
index frame of a clip when recorded. You can  
change it to another one as required (see page 88).  
The icon of the current memory card is highlighted, shading the nonselected one.  
(If the card is write-protected, a lock icon is displayed to the left.)  
Current clip No./ Total number of clips  
120  
m
in  
0011 /0300  
Cursor  
(yellow)  
OK  
OK  
01  
01  
01  
/
/
/
JAN 10:53  
JAN 14:53  
JAN 18:53  
01  
01  
01  
/
/
/
JAN 11:53  
JAN 15:53  
JAN 19:53  
01  
01  
01  
/
/
/
JAN 12 :53  
JAN 16 :53  
JAN 20 :53  
01  
01  
01  
/
/
/
JAN 13 :53  
OK  
OK  
OK  
JAN 17 :53  
8
OK  
JAN 21 :53  
01/ JAN / 2007 10 :53 S  
&
Q
Mot ion 29 /24fps TCR 00:00:00:00  
1
7
( )  
JPAN0011 1  
HQ 1080 / 24p  
DUR 00:03:19:23  
2
3 4  
5
6
Data for the clip at the cursor are displayed in 1 to 8.  
1. Date and starting time of recording  
2. Clip name  
3. OK mark  
Displayed only if the selected clip is marked OK  
an AV independent file, such as those added to  
the memory card using a computer. Not all  
operations and indications may be available for  
such clips.  
5. Recording video format  
6. Duration of the clip  
7. Timecode  
The timecode of the index frame is displayed.  
4. AV independent file icon  
Displayed if the selected clip is an AV  
independent file. This indicates that the clip is  
Playing Back Clips  
78  
           
8. Special recording information  
If the selected clip was recorded in a special  
recording mode (S&Q Motion, Interval Rec, or  
Frame Rec), the mode is displayed.  
For a clip recorded in S&Q Motion mode,  
[recording frame rate/playback frame rate] fps is  
displayed to the right.  
Playback  
For playback operations, use the playback control  
buttons on the handle.  
MONITOR VOL  
Joystick  
Switching the SxS memory cards  
THUMBNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
PLAY/PAUSE  
button  
When two memory cards are loaded, press the  
SLOT SELECT button to switch memory cards.  
F
REV PLAY/PAUSE  
/S  
F
FWD  
F FWD button  
F REV button  
PREV button  
STOP button  
j
G
J
PREV  
STOP  
NEXT  
l
s
L
NEXT button  
Note  
In Media mode, card switching is enabled only  
when the thumbnail screen is displayed or when  
an external input picture is displayed by pressing  
the STOP button.  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
O
T
T
E
/S  
D
I
N
L
FW  
F
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
You cannot switch memory cards during  
playback.  
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
3
0
1
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
E
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
A
SE  
IC  
TU  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
Displaying only the clips marked OK on  
the thumbnail screen  
LL  
LE  
C
T
I
AU  
TO  
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-
-1  
H
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
L
D
IO  
IN  
E
T
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
Press the THUMBNAIL button.  
• When the IR Remote Commander is enabled,  
you can use its playback control buttons instead  
MONITOR VOL  
THUMBNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
• Functions of the playback control buttons are  
occasionally assigned to the joystick (see page  
80).  
• The jog dial is also valid when you move the  
cursor on the thumbnail screen or proceed to the  
next step of operations.  
THUMBNAIL button  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
FW  
F
I
N
L
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
TR SH  
AN OT  
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
D
TO  
N
O
F
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
Playing back the selected and  
subsequent clips in sequence  
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
N
L/S  
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
E
-1  
H
-
C
C
W
IN  
W
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
E
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
1
Operating the joystick or jog dial, move  
the cursor to the thumbnail image of the  
clip with which you wish to start  
playback.  
The thumbnail screen changes such that it  
contains only the clips marked OK among the  
clips on the current memory card. To return to the  
thumbnail screen with all the clips, press the  
THUMBNAIL button again.  
2
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Playback starts from the beginning of the  
selected clip.  
For operations of the OK mark, see “Adding the OK  
The clips after the selected clips are played back  
in sequence.  
When playback of the last clip ends, the  
camcorder enters PAUSE (still picture) mode at  
the last frame of the last clip.  
Playing Back Clips  
79  
             
Display example (Playback mode):  
Press the THUMBNAIL button to return to the  
thumbnail screen.  
Function when tilted up (toward the subject)  
Notes  
PRV  
• The playback picture may be momentarily  
distorted or frozen between clips. The playback  
control buttons and THUMBNAIL button do  
not function during this condition.  
Function  
Function  
when tilted  
when tilted  
to the right  
to the left  
NXT  
• When you select a clip on the thumbnail button  
and start plaback, the playback picture at the  
beginning of the clip may be distorted. To start  
playback without distortion, once pause  
playback after starting it, press the PREV button  
to return to the top of the clip, then restart  
playback.  
Function when tilted down (toward the EVF)  
Guide marks Functions  
M
<
m
4-times playback in forward  
direction  
15-times playback in forward  
direction  
4-times playback in reverse  
direction  
Information displayed on the playback  
screen  
,
15-times playback in reverse  
direction  
The following information is superimposed on  
the playback picture.  
B
X
Normal playback  
Pause  
PRV  
Jump to the top of the current  
clip  
1
2
3
4
5
NXT  
Jump to the top of the next clip  
120min  
B PLAY  
TCR 00:00:00:00  
0011/03 00  
7. Audio levels  
The audio levels in recording are displayed.  
Pausing the playback  
PRV  
NXT  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The playback is restarted by pressing the button  
again.  
CH1  
CH2  
6
7
Switching to high-speed playback  
1. Battery remaining/DC IN voltage  
2. Playback mode  
3. SxS memory card in use  
A
The camcorder permits you to play clips at 4  
times or 15 times normal speed in the forward or  
reverse direction. Audio is muffled in high-speed  
playback.  
mark appears if the memory card is write-  
protected.  
To play at a high speed in the forward direction  
Press the F FWD button.  
Each time you press the button, the playback  
speed switches between 4 times and 15 times  
normal speed.  
4. Time data  
The time data for the playback picture are  
displayed. Each time you press the TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION button, the indication is switched  
between timecode (TCR) and user-bit (UB)  
data.  
To play at a high speed in the reverse direction  
Press the F REV button.  
Each time you press the button, the playback  
speed switches between 4 times and 15 times  
normal speed.  
5. Clip no./total number of clips on the  
memory card  
6. Joystick operation guidance area  
The functions assigned to the joystick in the  
current condition are displayed.  
To return to normal playback  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Playing Back Clips  
80  
             
With the headphones connected to the headphone  
jack, the built-in speaker is turned off.  
Press the MONITOR VOL buttons to adjust the  
sound volume.  
Cueing up  
To return to the top of the current clip  
Press the PREV button.  
The level bar is displayed during adjustment.  
You can select audio channel(s) to be monitored  
with “Audio Output” (page 102) of the AUDIO  
SET menu.  
• When you press the button in normal or fast-  
forward playback, the top of the current clip is  
cued up then playback begins.  
• When you press the button in fast-reverse  
playback or in Pause mode, the top of the  
current clip is cued up, then the still picture is  
displayed.  
Adding shot marks during playback  
In the same manner as in recording, you can add  
shot marks to the clip during playback.  
• Repeated pressing of the button cues up the  
previous clips one by one.  
At the point where you wish to add a shot  
mark, press the “Shot Mark1” or “Shot  
Mark2” assigned button, or the  
SHOTMARK 1 or 2 button on the IR  
Remote Commander.  
To start playback from the top of the first clip  
Press the PREV button and F REV button  
simultaneously. The top of the first-recorded clip  
on the memory card is cued up.  
To jump to the top of the next clip  
Press the NEXT button.  
Notes  
• No shot mark can be added if the memory card  
is write-protected.  
• No shot mark can be added to the first or last  
frame of a clip.  
• When you press the button in normal or fast-  
forward playback, the top of the next clip is  
cued up then playback begins.  
• When you press the button in fast-reverse  
playback or in Pause mode, the top of the next  
clip is cued up, then the still picture is displayed.  
• Repeated pressing of the button cues up the  
subsequent clips one by one.  
Stopping playback  
You can stop playback with either of the  
following operations:  
To start playback from the top of the last clip  
Press the F FWD button and NEXT button  
simultaneously. The top of the last-recorded clip  
on the memory card is cued up.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button.  
Playback mode is canceled, restoring the  
thumbnail screen.  
Press the STOP button.  
Playback mode is canceled, showing any external  
input or a blue screen.  
To display the thumbnail screen, press the  
THUMBNAIL button.  
Monitoring audio  
In Normal playback mode, you can monitor the  
recorded audio signals through the built-in  
speaker or connected headphones.  
Headphone  
connector  
MONITOR VOL buttons  
MONITOR VOL  
HDV  
M
O
N
IT  
TH  
OR  
U
V
O
M
B
L
N
A
IL  
S
E
L/  
S
ET  
F
R
E
C
A
V
P
N
C
LA  
Y
EL  
j
/P  
AU  
S
E
P
F
R
/
F
W
D
E
S
V
S
J
l
TO  
P
s
N
E
X
T
L
S
T
A
R
E
S
R
C
TO  
T/  
P
H
H
O
L
O
L
F
D
F
-2  
CH  
IN  
O
DI  
A
U
-1  
CH  
C
48V  
MI  
+
C
MI  
E
LIN  
C
+48V  
MI  
IC  
M
E
LIN  
R
E
LE  
A
S
E
R
T
N
S
H
O
A
A
S
T
T
I
O
I
O
N
B
N
O
B
F F  
G
I
H
L .  
T
T T A B  
D
I
N
I
Y
P S  
L
R U D  
B -  
C
T
O
F
A
T
A
T
I
U
/
S
R
A B  
N
O
I
/
M
A
C
/
T
A
T
S
S
U
SE  
L/  
SE  
T
C
AN  
C
EL  
C
AM  
ER  
O
FF  
A
M
ED  
IA  
C
C
H
-1  
PI  
A
M
U
AN  
C
O
TO  
UA  
TU  
R
FI  
PR  
E
LE  
D
C
L
IN  
EX  
AU  
LE  
T
T
IN  
D
IO  
T
SE  
-2  
C
A
U
IN  
D
IO  
H
A
M
U
TO  
UA  
AN  
T
N
L
IN  
NE  
O
T
T
P
M
EX  
A
TTERY  
CO UT  
O
B
ASE  
T
U
RELE  
O
V
A/  
P
M
W
-E  
X
1
T
U
O
I
SD  
Built-in speaker  
Playing Back Clips  
81  
                         
Clip Operations  
In Media mode, you can operate the clips or  
confirm and change the subsidiary data for clips  
using the Clip Operation menus.  
The corresponding Clip Operation menu pops up  
on the screens as shown below.  
Clip Operation Menus  
Thumbnail screen (page 83)  
Still picture in Pause mode (page 83)  
CANCEL  
CANCEL  
DISP CLIP INFO  
OK MARK ADD  
OK MARK DEL  
COPY CLIP  
DISP CLIP INFO  
OK MARK ADD  
SHOT MARK1 ADD  
SHOT MARK2 ADD  
EXPAND CLIP  
DELETE CLIP  
SHOT MARK  
SHOT MARK1  
SHOT MARK2  
EXPAND CLIP  
EXPAND CLIP screen (page 86)  
SHOT MARK screen (page 87)  
CANCEL  
CANCEL  
EXPAND (COARSE)  
EXPAND (FINE)  
PAUSE  
PAUSE  
SET INDEX PIC  
SHOT MARK1 DEL  
SHOT MARK2 DEL  
DIVIDE CLIP  
SET INDEX PIC  
SHOT MARK1 ADD  
SHOT MARK2 ADD  
SHOT MARK1 DEL  
SHOT MARK2 DEL  
DIVIDE CLIP  
Clip Operations  
82  
     
Item  
Function  
Basic Operations of the Clip  
Operation Menus  
SHOT MARK2 To display thumbnails only of the  
frames with shot mark 2 recorded  
EXPAND CLIP To display the EXPAND CLIP  
screen (page 85) for the clip  
Displaying a Clip Operation menu  
Press the joystick or the jog dial.  
The Clip Operation menu for the current display  
pops up.  
Clip Operation menu in Pause mode  
Pressing the joystick or the jog dial with a still  
picture displayed in Pause mode calls the Clip  
Operation menu for the clip in Pause mode.  
Selecting a Clip Operation menu item  
Turn the jog dial or tilt the joystick to select a  
menu item then press the jog dial or the joystick.  
Pressing the CANCEL button restores the  
previous condition.  
Item  
Function  
DISP CLIP INFO To display the CLIP INFO screen  
for the clip (page 84)  
Selecting “CANCEL” from a Clip Operation  
menu turns the Clip Operation menu off.  
OK MARK ADD To add the OK mark to the clip  
SHOT MARK1 To add shot mark 1 (page 86)  
ADD  
Notes  
• When the SxS memory card is write-protected,  
you cannot copy/delete/divide clips, change the  
index frames, and add/delete the OK and shot  
marks.  
SHOT MARK2 To add shot mark 2 (page 86)  
ADD  
EXPAND CLIP To display the EXPAND CLIP  
screen (page 85) for the clip  
• There may be items that cannot be selected  
depending on the status when the menu is  
displayed.  
Clip Operation menu on the thumbnail  
screen  
Pressing the joystick or the jog dial with the  
thumbnail screen (page 78) displayed calls the  
Clip Operation menu for the clip at the cursor.  
Item  
Function  
DISP CLIP  
INFO  
To display the CLIP INFO screen for  
the clip (page 84)  
OK MARK  
ADD  
To add the OK mark to the clip (page  
OK MARK  
DELETE  
COPY CLIP  
To delete the OK mark from the clip  
To copy the clip to another SxS  
memory card (page 85)  
DELETE CLIP To delete the clip (page 85)  
SHOT MARK To display thumbnails only of the  
frames with shot mark 1 and/or shot  
mark 2 recorded (page 86)  
SHOT MARK1 To display thumbnails only of the  
frames with shot mark 1 recorded  
Clip Operations  
83  
         
Displaying the Detailed Information of a Clip  
When you select “DISP CLIP INFO” from a Clip Operation menu, the CLIP INFO screen appears.  
120  
m
in  
CLIP I NFO  
0011/0300  
4
( )  
JPAN0011 1 OK  
01 / JAN/2007 10:53  
HQ 1080 /24p  
5
6
1
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
S
&Q  
Motion 29/24fps  
TCR 00:05:00:02  
TCR 00:05:00:00 STR  
TCR 00:08:19:23 END  
DUR 00:03:20:00  
CH1/CH2  
2
3
PREV CLIP  
NEXT CLIP  
1. Image of the current clip  
7. Recording format  
2. Image of the previous clip  
8. Special recording information  
If the selected clip was recorded in a special  
recording mode (S&Q Motion, Interval Rec, or  
Frame Rec), the mode is displayed.  
For a clip recorded in S&Q Motion mode,  
[recording frame rate/playback frame rate] fps is  
displayed to the right.  
Press the PREV button to switch to the CLIP  
INFO screen of the previous clip.  
3. Image of the next clip  
Press the NEXT button to switch to the CLIP  
INFO screen of the next clip.  
4. Clip name  
5. OK mark  
Displayed only when the selected clip is  
marked OK.  
9. Timecode of the displayed frame  
10. Timecode at the recording starting point  
11. Timecode at the recording ending point  
12. Duration of the clip  
6. Date and starting time of recording  
13. Recorded audio channels  
Adding the OK Mark to a Clip  
By adding the OK mark to clips, you can obtain a  
thumbnail screen of only the marked clips when  
you press the THUMBNAIL button.  
Clips with the OK mark cannot be deleted or  
divided. To delete or devide the clip, remove the  
OK mark.  
The CLIP INFO screen for the clip appears  
and a confirmation message appears below  
the index frame.  
2
Select “Execute,” and press the jog dial  
or the joystick.  
The OK mark is applied to the selected clip.  
Adding the OK mark  
Deleting the OK mark  
1
Select “OK MARK ADD” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
For a clip already marked with OK, the Clip  
Operation menu of the thumbnail screen permits  
you to select “OK MARK DEL.”  
Clip Operations  
84  
                 
ABCD0002(2) if ABCD0002(1) exists  
ABCD0005(4) if ABCD0005(3) exists  
• If parenthetical numbers (1) to (9) already exist  
as the result of repeated copying, copying to  
that card cannot be done any more.  
• A warning message is displayed if there is not  
sufficient space on the destination SxS memory  
card. Replace the SxS memory card with one  
with sufficient space.  
1
2
Select “OK MARK DEL” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
The information screen for the selected clip  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the index frame image.  
To delete, select “Execute” then press  
the jog dial or the joystick.  
The OK mark is deleted from the selected clip.  
To cancel copying on the way  
Press the CANCEL button.  
Copying is canceled and the thumbnail screen is  
restored.  
Copying a Clip  
You can copy a clip selected on the thumbnail  
screen to another SxS memory card.  
Deleting a Clip  
1
On the thumbnail screen of the current  
memory card, select the clip you wish to  
copy then press the joystick or the jog  
dial.  
You can delete a clip selected on the thumbnail  
screen from the SxS memory card.  
1
2
3
Select the clip you wish to delete on the  
thumbnail screen then press the  
joystick or the jog dial.  
The Clip Operation menu of the thumbnail  
screen pops up.  
2
3
Select “COPY CLIP” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
The Clip Operation menu of the thumbnail  
screen pops up.  
The information screen of the selected clip  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the index frame image.  
Select “DELETE CLIP” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
The information screen for the selected clip  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the index frame image.  
To copy, select “Execute” then press the  
jog dial or the joystick.  
Copying begins.  
To delete, select “Execute” then press  
the jog dial or the joystick.  
The clip is copied with the same name to the  
destination SxS memory card.  
The clip is deleted.  
An execution message and an in-progress bar are  
displayed during copying.  
When copying ends, the thumbnail screen is  
restored.  
The subsequent clips are shifted by one on the  
thumbnail screen.  
Notes  
Displaying the EXPAND CLIP  
Screen  
• If there is another clip having the same name on  
the destination SxS memory card, the clip is  
copied under a name adding a single-digit  
number in parentheses to the end of the original  
clip name.  
The parenthetical number is the minimum value  
that does not exist in the destination memory  
card.  
The EXPAND CLIP screen permits you to divide  
a clip into 12 blocks of equal duration and show a  
thumbnail image of the first frame of each block  
on the screen.  
This helps you to quickly cue up to a desired  
scene in a clip of long duration.  
You can display the EXPAND CLIP screen by  
selecting the clip on the thumbnail screen or on  
the still picture of the clip in Pause mode.  
Examples:  
ABCD0002(1) if ABCD0002 exists  
Clip Operations  
85  
                     
2. Timecode indication  
The timecode of the frame at the cursor is  
displayed.  
1
2
Pause the playback or select a clip on  
the thumbnail screen then press the  
joystick or the jog dial.  
The corresponding Clip Operation menu  
pops up.  
Clip Operation menu on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen  
Select “EXPAND CLIP” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
When you select a frame on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen and press the joystick or the jog dial, the  
Clip Operation menu pops up to enable further  
operations.  
The EXPAND CLIP screen appears for the  
clip in Pause mode or that you selected on the  
thumbnail screen.  
On the EXPAND CLIP screen displayed by  
using the Clip Operation menu in Pause  
mode, the clip is displayed with the finest  
possible partitions.  
Item  
Function  
EXPAND  
(COARSE)  
EXPAND  
(FINE)  
To decrease the number of  
partitions of the clip  
To increase the number of  
partitions of the clip  
PAUSE  
To set to Pause mode at the  
selected frame  
EXPAND CLIP screen  
SET INDEX PIC To specify the selected frame for  
the index frame of the clip (page  
Current frame number  
120  
m
in  
EXPAND CLIP  
01 : 10 : 30 : 00  
01 : 11 : 10 : 00  
01 : 11 : 50 : 00  
0000123  
SHOT MARK1  
ADD  
To add shot mark 1 to the selected  
SHOT MARK2  
ADD  
To add shot mark 2 to the selected  
01 : 10 : 20 : 00  
01 : 11 : 00 : 00  
01 : 11 : 40 : 00  
01:10:40:00  
01:11:20:00  
01:12:00:00  
01:10:50:00  
01:11:30:00  
01:12:10:00  
SHOT MARK1  
DEL  
To delete shot mark 1 from the  
selected frame (page 87)  
To delete shot mark 2 from the  
selected frame (page 87)  
S1  
S2  
SHOT MARK2  
DEL  
S2  
S1  
01/JAN /2007 10:53  
S
&
Q
Moti on 29 /24fps TCR 01:10:20:00  
DIVIDE CLIP  
To divide the clip into two clips at  
the selected frame (page 88)  
( )  
JPAN0011  
1
HQ 1080 /24p  
DUR 00:03:19:23  
1
2
Displaying the SHOT MARK  
Screen  
Detailed information for the clip is displayed at  
the bottom of the screen.  
The items other than the following are the same as  
those on the normal thumbnail screen:  
When one or more shot marks are recorded for a  
single clip, the SHOT MARK screen permits you  
to display only the marked frames as the  
thumbnail images on the screen.  
1. Frame information  
The following icons show the marking for the  
frame at the cursor.  
1
2
Select a clip on the thumbnail screen.  
Index frame  
Press the joystick or the jog dial.  
Frame with shot mark 1 added  
S1  
The Clip Operation menu pops up.  
Frame with shot mark 2 added  
S2  
3
Select “SHOT MARK,” “SHOT  
MARK1,” or “SHOT MARK2.”  
The same icons may also be displayed below the  
thumbnail image of each frame. If the frame has  
multiple markings, one of the icons is displayed,  
in the priority order of index frame, shot mark 1,  
and shot mark 2.  
SHOT MARK: To display thumbnails only  
of the frames marked with shot mark 1  
and/or shot mark 2 recorded  
SHOT MARK1: To display thumbnails only  
of the frames marked with shot mark 1  
Clip Operations  
86  
               
SHOT MARK2: To display thumbnails only  
of the frames marked with shot mark 2  
Adding a shot mark in Pause mode  
1
Pause the playback at the frame to  
which you wish to add a shot mark then  
press the joystick or the jog dial.  
SHOT MARK screen example  
120  
m
in  
SHOT MARK  
01 : 10 : 30 : 00  
01 : 11 : 10 : 00  
- - -  
0031 / 0031  
The Clip Operation menu pops up.  
S1  
S1  
S2  
S1  
S2  
S1  
01:10:50:00  
01 : 10 : 20 : 00  
01 : 11 : 00 : 00  
- - -  
01:10:40:00  
2
Select “SHOT MARK1 ADD” or  
“SHOT MARK2 ADD” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
- - -  
- - -  
- - -  
The information screen for the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the image.  
- - -  
01/JAN /2007 10:53  
S
&
Q
Moti on 29 /24fps TCR 01:12:00:00  
( )  
JPAN0011  
1
HQ 1080 /24p  
DUR 00:03:19:23  
3
Select “Execute.”  
1
The detailed information of the clip is displayed  
at the bottom of the screen.  
The items other than the following are the same as  
those on the EXPAND CLIP screen:  
Adding a shot mark on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen  
1
2
Select the frame to which you wish to  
add a shot mark on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen then press the joystick or the jog  
dial.  
1. Timecode indication  
The timecode of the frame at the cursor on the  
SHOT MARK screen is displayed.  
The Clip Operation menu pops up.  
Clip Operation menu on the SHOT MARK  
screen  
Select “SHOT MARK1 ADD” or  
“SHOT MARK2 ADD” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
When you select a frame on the SHOT MARK  
screen and press the joystick or the jog dial, the  
Clip Operation menu pops up to permit you  
further operations.  
The information screen for the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the image.  
Item  
Function  
PAUSE  
To set to Pause mode at the selected  
frame  
3
Select “Execute.”  
SET INDEX PIC To specify the selected frame for the  
index frame of the clip (page 88)  
Deleting a shot mark  
SHOT MARK1 To delete the shot mark 1 from the  
You can delete shot marks on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen (page 85) or on the SHOT MARK screen  
DEL  
selected frame (page 87)  
SHOT MARK2 To delete the shot mark 2 from the  
DEL  
selected frame (page 87)  
DIVIDE CLIP  
To divide the clip into two clips at  
the selected frame (page 88)  
1
Select a frame from which you wish to  
delete the shot mark on the EXPAND  
CLIP screen or the SHOT MARK  
screen then press the joystick or the jog  
dial.  
Adding/Deleting Shot Marks  
The Clip Operation menu pops up.  
You can add shot marks to the clips after  
recording or delete the recorded shot marks.  
2
Select the “SHOT MARK1 DEL” or  
“SHOT MARK2 DEL” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
Clip Operations  
87  
                 
The information screen for the selected frame  
appears and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the image.  
3
Select “Execute.”  
The selected and subsequent frames are  
divided, creating two clips having different  
names.  
3
Select “Execute.”  
The first 4 characters of the original clip name are  
carried on, continuing to the last number on the  
memory card by the second 4 numerics.  
Changing the Index Frame  
Example: If you divide a clip named ABCD0002  
into two clips under the condition where a  
new clip will be named EFGH0100, clip  
You can change the index frame of a clip to  
another frame you selected on the EXPAND  
CLIP screen (page 85) or the SHOT MARK  
screen (page 86).  
ABCD0100 and clip ABCD0101 are created.  
Note  
1
Select a frame to be the index frame on  
the EXPAND CLIP screen or the SHOT  
MARK screen then press the joystick or  
the jog dial.  
If the remaining space on the memory card is  
insufficient for divided clips, a message  
informing you of it appears.  
2
Select “SET INDEX PIC” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
The information screen of the selected frame  
appears and the confirmation message is  
displayed below the image.  
3
Select “Execute.”  
Note  
Even if you specify a frame other than the top  
frame for the index frame, playback always  
begins from the top frame when you start it from  
the thumbnail screen.  
Dividing a Clip  
You can divide a clip into two different clips at  
the frame you select on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen (page 85) or the SHOT MARK screen  
1
Select the frame at which the clip is to  
be divided on the EXPAND CLIP  
screen or the SHOT MARK screen then  
press the joystick or the jog dial.  
The Clip Operation menu pops up.  
2
Select “DIVIDE CLIP” from the Clip  
Operation menu.  
The information screen for the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message is  
displayed below the image.  
Clip Operations  
88  
           
Status Displays  
Showing the Status Screens  
This camcorder provides status screens of five  
kinds in Camera mode and four kinds in Media  
mode, permitting you to check the various  
settings and statuses of this unit.  
Switching the status screens  
Operating the joystick or the jog dial switches the  
screens in sequence.  
The status screens can also be displayed on an  
external monitor.  
Canceling the status screen display  
For connections of an external monitor,see  
Press the STATUS button again. The status  
screen display is canceled.  
Available status screens  
• CAMERA status screen (displayed only in  
Camera mode) (page 90)  
• AUDIO status screen (page 91)  
• VIDEO status screen (page 92)  
• BUTTON/REMOTE status screen (page 92)  
• BATTERY/MEDIA status screen (page 93)  
STATUS button  
TC/U-BIT/  
DURATION  
A
B
STATUS  
SHOT  
TRANSITION  
LCD B.LIGHT  
DISPLAY  
BATT INFO  
BARS/CAM  
ON  
OFF  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
N
L
FW  
F
I
O
E
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
P
T
X
N
B
/
E
N
M
Y
A
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
OP  
T
/
S
E
C
R
E
P
R
T
R
A
T
S
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
T
R
S
H
A
N
O
T
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
1.2  
OF  
/
8
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
M
40  
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
D
TO  
N
O
FF  
M
E
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
I
N
8
C
.
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
/S  
R
N
L
U
E
T
A
S
IC  
FOCUS  
P
P
F
ILE  
M
O
ZE  
B
S
S
EN  
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MA  
O
FF  
NU  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
-1  
H
-E  
W
C
C
N
W
I
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
P
U
E
AU  
A
S
C
T
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
MONITOR VOL  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
MENU  
THUMNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
Joystick  
Jog dial  
Activating the status screen display  
Press the STATUS button.  
Showing the Status Screens  
89  
         
Zebra: Zebra status  
Display Contents  
CAMERA Status Screen  
1
This indication becomes “On” if you turn  
zebra on with the ZEBRA button when “1”  
or “Both” is selected for “Zebra Select” of  
the LCD/VF SET menu. The setting value  
of “Zebra1 Level” of the LCD/VF SET  
menu is displayed at the right.  
The settings and statuses related to image  
shooting are displayed.  
It shows “Off” when zebra is off or “2” is  
selected for “Zebra Select.”  
The CAMERA status screen is obtained only in  
Camera mode. It is not displayed in Media mode.  
2
This indication becomes “On” if you turn  
zebra on with the ZEBRA button when “2”  
or “Both” is selected for “Zebra Select” of  
the LCD/VF SET menu.  
CA  
W
M
ERA  
1/5  
hite Bal B: 12000K  
A : 4700K  
Gain L : 0dB  
M: 9dB  
PRST  
:
3200K  
H: 18dB  
H
andle  
Z
oo  
m
S
peed H: 70  
Zebra1:  
O
O
n
f f  
70%  
It shows “Off” when zebra is off or “1” is  
selected for “Zebra Select.”  
L: 30  
2:  
Skin Tone  
D
etai l :  
O
f f  
Pict ure Prof i l e  
:
PP1 STANDARD  
Skin Tone Detail: Skin-tone detail status  
The current status (On or Off) of “Setting” of  
“Skin Tone Detail” of the PICTURE PROFILE  
menu is displayed.  
White Bal: White balance status  
Display Contents  
B
The color temperature stored in white  
memory B is indicated. The color  
Picture Profile: Picture Profile selection status  
The selected Picture Profile number and name are  
displayed. (If Picture Profile is off, “Off” is  
displayed.)  
temperature of white memory B is detected/  
stored when you execute the auto white  
balance operation in Memory B mode.  
The color temperature stored in white  
memory A is indicated. The color  
temperature of white memory A is  
detected/stored when you execute the auto  
white balance operation in Memory A  
mode.  
A
PRST  
The color temperature set as the preset  
white is indicated. The color temperature of  
preset white can be changed using the  
PICTURE PROFILE menu.  
Gain: GAIN switch settings  
The gain values of the positions L, M, and H of  
the GAIN switch assigned with the CAMERA  
SET menu are displayed.  
Handle Zoom Speed: Handle zoom speed  
settings  
The speed values assigned to the on-handle  
ZOOM button on the CAMERA SET menu are  
displayed.  
Display Contents  
H
Speed obtained when the speed switch is  
set to the H position  
L
Speed obtained when the speed switch is  
set to the L position  
CAMERA Status Screen  
90  
   
In Media Mode  
AUDIO Status Screen  
AUDIO  
1/4  
CH-3  
CH-4  
oo  
-40  
-30  
-20  
-
10  
0
OVER  
Information regarding audio signals is displayed.  
The display configuration varies between Camera  
mode and Media mode.  
O
utput  
C
H
:
:
:
CH-3/CH-4  
CH-3/CH-4  
CH-3+CH-4  
Headphones  
peaker  
S
CH-1/CH-2/CH-3/CH-4: Audio level meters  
The playback audio levels of CH-1/CH-2 or CH-  
3/CH-4 are displayed according to the “Output  
CH” setting of the AUDIO SET menu.  
If audio input is fed in via the i.LINK connector  
in STOP status or in external input recording, the  
input audio levels are indicated. In this case, the  
channel indications at the left of the meters are  
CH-1 and CH-2 regardless of the “Output CH”  
setting of the AUDIO SET menu.  
In Camera Mode  
AUDIO  
CH-1  
2/5  
CH-2  
oo  
-40  
-30  
-20  
-10  
0
OVER  
W
ind Fi l ter CH-1:  
CH-2:  
O
O
n
n
AGC Link: Linked  
EXT-1  
EXT-2  
CH-1  
CH-2  
In other conditions, the meters do not function.  
CH-1/CH-2: Audio level meters  
Output CH: Output channel setting  
The “Output CH” setting of the AUDIO SET  
menu is displayed.  
The levels of the CH-1 and CH-2 audio inputs (E-  
E audio levels) are displayed.  
Wind Filter: Wind filter settings  
The current settings of “Wind Filter CH-1” and  
“Wind Filter CH-2” of the AUDIO SET menu are  
displayed.  
Headphones: Headphone output  
The output audio channel(s) for the headphones  
is(are) displayed. The “Monitor CH” setting of  
the AUDIO SET menu is valid as-is.  
AGC Link: AGC link status  
Speaker: Speaker output  
The “AGC Link” status (Linked or Separate) of  
The output audio channel(s) for the built-in  
speaker is(are) displayed. As the speaker is  
monaural, the outputs are CH-1+CH2 or CH-  
3+CH4 even in stereo mode.  
With nonstereo settings, the “Monitor CH”  
setting of the AUDIO SET menu is valid as-is.  
the AUDIO SET menu is displayed.  
INT/EXT–CH-1/CH-2: Audio input settings  
The inputs to CH-1 and CH-2 according to the  
“EXT CH Select” setting of the AUDIO SET  
menu and the AUDIO IN switch status are  
displayed.  
AUDIO IN EXT CH Display  
switch  
Select  
CH-1: INT  
CH-2: INT  
INT-L  
INT-R  
CH-1  
CH-2  
CH-1: EXT  
CH-2: INT  
EXT-1  
INT-R  
CH-1  
CH-2  
CH-1: INT  
CH-2: EXT  
INT-L  
EXT-2  
CH-1  
CH-2  
CH-1: EXT CH-1/CH-2  
CH-2: EXT  
EXT-1  
EXT-2  
CH-1  
CH-2  
CH-1: EXT CH-1  
CH-2: EXT  
EXT-1  
EXT-2  
CH-1  
CH-2  
AUDIO Status Screen  
91  
       
VIDEO Status Screen  
BUTTON/REMOTE Status  
Screen  
The information on video formats and settings for  
the COMPONENT OUT, SDI OUT, A/V OUT,  
i.LINK connectors is displayed.  
The functions assigned to the assignable buttons  
and the status of the IR Remote Commander are  
displayed.  
VIDEO  
V ideo For  
Rec ode  
YP r /SD  
V ideo  
3/5  
BUTTON /RE  
Assign But ton 1: Freeze  
M
OTE  
4/5  
m
at  
ut  
:
:
:
:
:
:
1080/60i  
HQ  
1080/60i  
M
ix  
M
P
2:  
3:  
O
O
ff  
ff  
b
I
O
O
ut  
O
ff  
4: Rec Rev iew  
Down  
Conver ter  
Squeeze  
Disable  
i .  
L
I
NK I /  
O
I R Rem  
ote  
:
On  
Video Format: Video format setting  
Assign Button: Assignable button statuses  
The picture size (effective vertical lines), frame  
rate, and scan format set in “Video Format” of the  
OTHERS menu are displayed.  
The functions assigned with the “Assign Button”  
of the OTHERS menu to the respective  
assignable buttons are displayed.  
Rec Mode: Recording bit rate  
The bit rate (HQ or SP) set in “Video Format” of  
the OTHERS menu is displayed.  
IR Remote: IR Remote Commander status  
The status (On: enabled, Off: disabled) of the IR  
Remote Commander is displayed  
YPbPr/SDI Out: Component and SDI output status  
The picture size (effective vertical lines), frame  
rate, and scan format of the signal being fed from  
the COMPONENT OUT and SDI OUT  
connectors according to the “YPbPr/SDI Out  
Select” setting of the VIDEO SET menu are  
displayed.  
Video Out: Output status of the A/V OUT  
connector  
“Off” is displayed when “YPbPr/SDI Out Select”  
of the VIDEO SET menu is set to “HD” or “SD.”  
The format (NTSC or PAL) of the analog com-  
posite signal being fed from the A/V OUT con-  
nector is displayed when “YPbPr/SDI Out  
Select” of the VIDEO SET menu is set to “Off.”  
Down Converter: Down-converter setting of the  
SD output  
The “Down Converter” setting (Squeeze, Edge  
Crop, Letterbox) of the VIDEO SET menu is  
displayed.  
i.LINK I/O: i.LINK I/O status  
The i.LINK I/O setting (Enable /Disable) of the  
OTHERS menu is displayed.  
VIDEO Status Screen / BUTTON/REMOTE Status Screen  
92  
       
BATTERY/MEDIA Status  
Screen  
The information on the battery pack and SxS  
memory cards is displayed.  
BATTERY/  
Bat tery  
MEDIA  
5/5  
0
ount  
50  
50  
100  
100  
%
Charge  
C
:
55  
M
M
edia  
edia  
A
B
20  
50  
m
m
in  
in  
Protected  
0
%
Battery: Battery charge remaining  
The remaining charge level of the mounted  
battery pack is displayed.  
Charge Count: Repeated charge times  
The number of times that the mounted battery  
pack has been charged is displayed.  
Media A/Media B: Remaining space and  
available recording time  
The remaining space of the SxS memory cards in  
the respective card slots are indicated on the  
meters.  
At the right, the available time for recording if  
done at the current bit rate is displayed, in  
minutes.  
The time indication will be “- - min” if no SxS  
memory card or an invalid card is in the slot.  
If the card is write-protected, “Protected” is  
shown to the right of the time indication.  
BATTERY/MEDIA Status Screen  
93  
   
Menu Configuration and Detailed Settings  
Overview of the Setup Menus  
This camcorder permits you to make various  
settings for recording and playback with Setup  
menus on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
Setup Menu Layers  
The Setup menus can also be displayed on an  
external monitor.  
MENU  
CAMERA SET  
Gain Setup  
For connections of an external monitor, see  
Shutter  
EX Slow Shutter  
Shot Transition  
MF Assist  
Setup Menu Configuration  
Color Bar Type  
Flicker Reduce  
Zoom Speed  
Interval Rec  
Frame Rec  
The following menu icons are displayed when  
you press the MENU button, permitting you to  
select the corresponding menus.  
S&Q Motion  
Rec Review  
Fader  
CAMERA SET menu  
For setting the items related to recording other  
than those on picture quality (page 98).  
The picture-quality items are set with the PICTURE  
PROFILE menu (page 72).  
TLCS  
Shockless White  
White Switch<B>  
ATW Speed  
Wide Conversion  
Steady Shot  
AUDIO SET menu  
For setting the audio-related items (page 102).  
VIDEO SET menu  
For setting the items related to video outputs  
AUDIO SET  
Audio Input  
Audio Output  
LCD/VF SET menu  
For setting the items related to the displays on the  
LCD monitor /EVF (page 104).  
VIDEO SET  
YPbPr/SDI Out Select  
YPbPr/SDI Out Display  
Video Out Display  
Setup  
00:00  
TC/UB SET menu  
For setting the items related to timecodes and user  
Down Converter  
bits (page 106).  
LCD/VF SET  
LCD  
OTHERS menu  
EVF  
For setting the other items (page 106).  
Peaking  
Marker  
Zebra  
Display On/Off  
TC/UB SET  
Timecode  
Users Bit  
TC Format  
(continues)  
Overview of the Setup Menus  
94  
         
OTHERS  
All Reset  
Basic Menu Operations  
Camera Data  
Time Zone  
Clock Set  
Language  
Assign Button  
Tally  
This section covers basic operations for setting  
the Setup menu items.  
Hours Meter  
IR Remote  
Battery Alarm  
Battery INFO  
Direct Menu  
i.LINK I/O  
Menu controls  
Joystick  
MENU button  
Jog dial  
CANCEL button  
Trigger Mode  
Country  
MONITOR VOL  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
MENU  
Video Format  
Clip  
THUMNAIL SEL/SET CANCEL  
Format Media  
CANCEL  
button  
L
E
C
N
A
L
O
C
V
R
T
E
/S  
O
T
D
FW  
I
N
L
O
E
F
M
S
E
S
IL  
A
AU  
T
X
N
P
B
/
E
N
M
A
Y
U
L
P
/
H
T
V
E
P
TO  
R
F
S
V
E
OP  
T
C
R
E
P
R
/
S
T
R
A
T
S
D
L
O
H
H
L
F
F
O
C
W
IE  
E
R
V
E
R
A
T
R
S
H
A
N
O
T
SIT  
IO  
B
N
LC  
D
B
.LI  
GH  
ON  
T
TC  
DU /U-  
RA BIT  
TIO  
OF  
/
81.2  
F
N
ST  
DIS  
BA  
TT  
A
T
US  
PL  
IN  
A
Y
FO  
BA  
RS  
/CA  
0
M
4
LE  
NS  
IN  
IR  
FO  
BR  
IS  
T
DI  
5
SP  
HI  
2
ST  
OG  
RA  
M
0
0
1
3
1
ND  
FIL  
M
AN  
U
TE  
2
A
SS  
IA  
AU  
R
IG  
F
TO  
N
O
F
M
ED  
3
5
1
MA  
5
CR  
R
A
O
E
M
2
A
1
C
L
E
0
C
3
N
1
C
A
IN  
8
.
C
D
O
1
5
FF  
T
E
E
O
R
N
L/S  
E
TU  
A
S
IC  
E
FOCUS  
P
P
F
IL  
M
EN  
O
ZE  
B
S
S
R
BR  
U
A
AC  
CE  
PE  
AK  
IN  
SLO  
T
SE  
G
FU  
NT  
EX  
LL  
LEC  
I
AU  
TO  
T
T
MANU  
O
FF  
AU  
TO  
T
O
A
M
U
AL  
U
N
A
G
AI  
IO  
1
X
N
D
CH  
-1  
A
U
-1  
H
-E  
W
C
C
W
IN  
L
M
H
HIT  
E
BA  
M
P
L
D
IO  
LE  
IN  
E
T
U
E
AU  
A
S
CT  
XT  
B
DIO  
LE  
A
V
T
O
PRST  
EL  
A
U
L
A
U
N
A
M
-2  
CH  
H
-2  
O
PE  
N
MENU button  
To turn Menu mode to use Setup menus on/off.  
Joystick (SEL/SET button)  
When you tilt it, the cursor moves in the  
corresponding direction, permitting you to select  
menu items or setting values.  
Jog dial (SEL/SET dial)  
When you turn the dial, the cursor moves up or  
down, permitting you to select menu items or  
setting values.  
CANCEL button  
To return to the previous layer of the menu. An  
uncompleted change is canceled.  
Displaying the Setup menu  
Press the MENU button.  
The menu icons appear on the screen.  
The cursor is displayed on the icon of the menu  
used last, and the corresponding menu item  
selection area is displayed to the right.  
Basic Menu Operations  
95  
                         
Example: When the cursor is located at  
(CAMERA SET menu icon)  
C
A
M
E
R
A
SET  
Return  
B
B
B
B
Gain Setup  
Shu t ter  
Menu icon  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
Shutter  
00:00  
CA  
MER  
A
SET  
A
:
:
Of f  
Mul t i  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shut ter  
B
T
ype  
B
B
B
B
:
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
Shutter  
Displayed when there are more  
menu items beneath. (v shown at  
the top indicates that there are  
more menu items above.)  
00:00  
A
Of f  
Mul t i  
B
T
ype  
:
Menu item selection area  
Menu item selection area  
• A B symbol is displayed to the right of any item  
Note  
that has subitems.  
• The current setting value is displayed to the  
right of an item that has no subitems.  
• To return to the previous layer, select “Return”  
or tilt the joystick to the left.  
When the camcorder is in EXPAND FOCUS  
mode (page 48), the Setup menus cannot be  
operated. Press the EXPAND FOCUS button to  
release the mode.  
3
Turn the jog dial or tilt the joystick  
back or forth to set the cursor to the  
menu item you wish to set then press the  
dial or the joystick to proceed.  
Setting the Setup menus  
1
Rotate the jog dial or tilt the joystick  
back or forth to set the cursor to the  
icon of the menu you wish to set.  
The setting area appears to the right of the  
menu item selection area, and the cursor  
moves to the top of its subitems.  
The selectable menu items are displayed in  
the menu item selection area to the right of  
the icon.  
CA  
ME  
RA  
SET  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shut ter  
Return  
Low  
Mid  
2
Press the jog dial or the joystick.  
B
B
B
B
:
:
:
:
0dB  
9dB  
18dB  
The cursor moves to the menu item selection  
area.  
You can also move the cursor to the menu  
item selection area by tilting the joystick to  
the right.  
• The menu item selection area can show 7  
lines at maximum. When all the selectable  
items cannot be displayed at one time, you  
can scroll the display up or down by  
moving the cursor.  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
S
hutter  
High  
00:00  
A
Of f  
Mul t i  
B
T
ype  
:
Setting area  
• The subitems and their current values are  
displayed.  
• To return to the previous layer, select “Return”  
or tilt the joystick to the left.  
A triangle appears at the upper or lower  
right corner of the menu item selection area  
to indicate that scrolling is enabled.  
When you select an item that has no subitems  
and to be only On /Off or switched, the  
choices are displayed to the right of the item.  
In this case, proceed to step 5.  
Basic Menu Operations  
96  
For an item that requires your confirmation  
When you select an item that you must confirm  
before execution in step 3, the menu display  
temporarily disappears, and a confirmation  
message is displayed. Following the instructions  
of message, specify whether to execute or cancel.  
Example  
CA  
ME  
R
A
SET  
Return  
Gain Setup  
Shut ter  
B
B
B
B
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
Shutter  
00:00  
On  
Of f  
i  
A
:
:
Entering a character string  
B
T
ype  
When you select an item for which a character  
string, such as a time value or filename, is to be  
specified, the input area for the character string is  
highlighted, and “SET” appears at the right end.  
Choices  
4
For the item that has subitems, turn the  
jog dial or tilt the joystick back or forth  
to set the cursor to the subitem you wish  
to set then press the dial or the joystick  
to proceed.  
1
Select characters by turning the jog dial  
or tilting the joystick back and forth  
then press the dial or joystick to  
proceed.  
The available values of the selected subitems  
are displayed, and the cursor moves to the  
current value.  
The cursor moves to the next column.  
To return to the previous column, tilt the  
joystick to the left.  
CA  
ME  
RA  
SET  
Return  
Return 18dB  
B
B
B
B
:
Gain Setup  
Shut ter  
Low  
Mid  
High  
:
:
12dB  
9dB  
6dB  
3dB  
0dB  
2
3
Perform setting in the same manner up  
to the last column/digit.  
EX  
Shot Transi t ion  
MF ssis t  
Color ar  
S
lo  
w
Shutter  
00:00  
The cursor moves to “SET.”  
A
Of f  
Mul t i  
B
T
ype  
:
-3dB  
Press the jog dial or the joystick.  
The setting is completed.  
Available value area  
• The available value area can show 7 lines at  
maximum. When all the selectable values  
cannot be displayed at one time, you can  
scroll the display up or down by moving the  
cursor.  
Terminating the menu operation  
Press the MENU button.  
The normal camera picture is resumed.  
A triangle appears at the upper or lower  
right corner of the available value area to  
indicate that scrolling is enabled.  
• For items having a wide range of available  
values (example: –99 to +99), the available  
value area is not displayed. The current  
setting is highlighted instead, indicating  
that the setting is ready for change.  
5
Select the desired value by turning the  
jog dial or tilting the joystick back or  
forth then press the dial or the joystick  
to make the setting.  
The setting is changed, and the new setting is  
displayed.  
When you select “Execute” for an execution  
item, the corresponding function is executed.  
Basic Menu Operations  
97  
 
Setup Menu List  
The functions and available settings of menus are listed below.  
The default settings set at the factory are shown in bold face (example: Speed).  
CAMERA SET Menu  
CAMERA SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Low Set the gain level to be used when the switch is set to the L  
–3 / 0 / 3 / 6 / 9 /12 /18 dB  
Mid  
–3 / 0 / 3 / 6 / 9 /12 /18 dB  
High  
–3 / 0 / 3 / 6 / 9 /12 / 18 dB  
Mode  
Speed / Angle / ECS / SLS  
Gain Setup  
Assigning gain  
levels to the three  
GAIN switch  
positions  
position.  
Set the gain level to be used when the switch is set to the M  
position.  
Set the gain level to be used when the switch is set to the H  
position.  
Select modes of the Electronic Shutter.  
Shutter  
Specifying  
operating  
Shutter Speed  
Set the shutter speed when Speed mode is selected.  
conditions of the  
electrical shutter  
1/100  
The available setting values vary depending on the video  
format being selected (see page 43).  
Shutter Angle  
Set the shutter angle when Angle mode is selected.  
180º / 90º / 45º / 22.5º / 11.25º  
ECS Frequency  
Set the ECS frequency when ECS mode is selected.  
60.02  
The available setting values vary depending on the frame rate  
of the video format selected.  
SLS Frame  
2 to 8  
Set the number of frames to accumulate when SLS mode is  
selected.  
Setting  
Turn EX Slow Shutter mode on/off.  
EX Slow  
On / Off  
Shutter  
Setting the  
Number of Frames  
Set the number of frames to accumulate.  
Supersensitized  
Slow Shutter mode  
16 / 32 / 64  
Setup Menu List  
98  
           
CAMERA SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Trans Time Set the time it takes to make a shot transition.  
2 to 15 sec (4 sec)  
Shot  
Transition  
Setting the  
operating  
Trans Speed  
Set the speed of the transition.  
1 to 10 (5)  
conditions of Shot  
Transition  
Time / Speed  
Time / Speed  
Determine whether to specify the transition by time or speed.  
Select the transition pattern.  
Trans Curve  
Linear / Soft Trans / Soft Stop Linear: To make the transition linearly  
Soft Trans: To make the transition slowly at the beginning and  
end, but linearly in between  
Soft Stop: To make the transition slow down near the end  
Start Timer  
Off / 5 sec / 10 sec / 20 sec  
Rec Link  
Off / Shot-A / Shot-B  
Set the waiting time until the shot transition begins.  
Set the function to start a shot transition linked to recording  
start.  
Off: To start the transition using a button without linked to  
recording start  
Shot-A: To start a transition to Shot-A linked to recording  
start  
Shot-B: To start a transition to Shot-B linked to recording  
start  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to precisely adjust the focus automatically after  
you roughly adjust it manually.  
MF Assist  
Turning the MF  
Assist Function  
on/off  
Multi / 75% / 100%  
Select the type of color bars displayed when you press the  
BARS/CAM button.  
Multi: To output multiformat color bars  
75%: To output 75% color bars  
Color Bar Type  
Selecting the types  
of color bar  
100%: To output 100% color bars  
Mode  
Auto / On / Off  
Set the operation of the Flicker-Reduction function.  
On: To always activate it  
Auto: To automatically activate it when flicker is detected.  
Off: To not activate it  
Flicker Reduce  
Setting Flicker  
Compensation  
Frequency  
50 Hz / 60 Hz  
High  
0 to 99 (70)  
Set to the power supply frequency of the light source causing  
flicker.  
Set the speed of zooming to be executed when you press the  
on-handle ZOOM button with the zoom speed switch set to  
H.  
Zoom Speed  
Setting the zoom  
speed  
Low  
0 to 99 (30)  
Remote  
0 to 99 (50)  
Set the speed of zooming to be executed when you press the  
on-handle ZOOM button with the zoom speed switch set to L.  
Set the speed of zooming to be executed when you press the  
ZOOM button of the IR Remote Commander.  
Setup Menu List  
99  
         
CAMERA SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Setting Turn the Interval Recording function on/off.  
On / Off  
Interval Rec  
Setting the Interval  
Recording  
Interval Time  
Set the interval of recording in Interval Recording.  
function  
1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 sec  
1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 min  
1 to 4/6/12/24 hour  
Number of Frames  
1 / 3 / 6 / 9 or  
Set the number of frames to be recorded at a time in Interval  
Recording.  
2 / 6 /12 (720/60P, 720/50P)  
Setting  
On / Off  
Turn the Frame Recording function on/off.  
Frame Rec  
Setting the Frame  
Recording  
Number of Frames  
1 / 3 / 6 / 9 or  
Set the number of frames to be recorded at a time in Frame  
Recording.  
function  
2 / 6 /12 (720/60P, 720/50P)  
Setting  
On / Off  
Turn the Slow & Quick Motion function on/off.  
S&Q Motion  
Setting the S&Q  
Motion function  
Frame Rate  
1 to 30 (1080 size)  
1 to 60 (720 size)  
Set the recording frame rate in Slow & Quick Motion  
recording.  
3 sec / 10 sec / Clip  
Set the time to play the last recorded clip using the Rec-  
Review function.  
Rec Review  
Setting the  
3 sec: Last 3 seconds  
10 sec: Last 10 seconds  
playback time for  
Rec-Review  
Clip: Entire duration of the clip  
Fade In  
Turn the fade-in function on/off.  
Fader  
On / Off  
Setting the fade-in/  
fade-out functions  
Fade In Type  
Select the fade-in mode.  
White / Black  
White: To fade in from a white screen  
Black: To face in from a black screen  
Fade In Time  
Set the duration of the fade in.  
1 sec / 2 sec / 3 sec / 5 sec /  
10 sec  
Fade Out  
Turn the fade-out function on/off.  
On / Off  
Fade Out Type  
Select the fade-out mode.  
White / Black  
White: To fade out to a white screen  
Black: To face out to a black screen  
Fade Out Time  
Set the duration of the fade out.  
1 sec / 2 sec / 3 sec / 5 sec /  
10 sec  
Setup Menu List  
100  
         
CAMERA SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Level Set the target level (to make brighter or darker) of auto iris  
+1.0 / +0.5 / 0 / –0.5 / –1.0  
TLCS  
control in TLCS. (This setting also affects the gain control in  
AGC mode and shutter-speed control in Auto Shutter mode.)  
+1.0: Approx. one stop further open  
Setting the Total  
Level Control  
System (auto  
adjustment system  
of gain, iris and  
shutter)  
+0.5: Approx. half a stop further open  
0: Standard  
–0.5: Approx. half a stop further closed  
–1.0: Approx. one stop further closed  
Mode  
Backlight / Standard /  
Spotlight  
Set the auto iris control mode in TLCS.  
Backlight: Backlight mode to reduce darkening of the center  
subject against lights  
Standard: Standard mode  
Spotlight: Spotlight mode to reduce blown-out highlights on  
the center subject in the spotlight  
Speed  
–99 to +99 (+50)  
AGC  
Set the tracing speed of TLCS control.  
Turn the AGC (Auto Gain Control) function on/off.  
Set the maximum gain in AGC.  
On / Off  
AGC Limit  
3 / 6 / 9 / 12 / 18 dB  
AGC Point  
F5.6 / F4 / F2.8  
Set the iris point for switching to auto-iris and auto-shutter  
control when AGC is on.  
Auto Shutter  
Turn the Auto Shutter control function on/off.  
On / Off  
A.SHT Limit  
1/100  
Set the maximum shutter speed in Auto Shutter control.  
1/150  
1/200  
1/250  
A.SHT Point  
F5.6 / F8 / F11 / F16  
Set the iris point for switching auto-iris and auto-shutter  
control when Auto Shutter is on.  
Off / 1 / 2 / 3  
Select the speed of change in white balance when the white  
balance mode is switched.  
Shockless  
White  
Set to “Off” to instantly change the white balance.  
Select a larger number to change the white balance more  
slowly through interpolation.  
Setting the  
shockless white  
balance  
ATW / MEM  
Select the mode (ATW or Memory B) selected at the B  
position of the WHITE BAL switch.  
White Switch  
<B>  
Setting for the  
WHITE BAL  
switch  
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5  
Set the tracing speed of ATW.  
The larger the number you set, the speed becomes faster.  
ATW Speed  
Setting for Auto  
Tracing White  
Balance  
On / Off  
Set to “On” when a wide conversion lens is attached.  
Wide  
Conversion  
Setting for use of a  
wide conversion  
lens  
Setup Menu List  
101  
         
CAMERA SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
On / Off Turn the Steady Shot (image stabilizer) function on/off.  
Steady Shot  
Setting the image  
stabilizer  
AUDIO SET Menu  
AUDIO SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
TRIM CH-1 Finely adjust the sensitivity of channel 1 of external  
–8 dBu to –65 dBu (–41 dBu) microphone input in steps of 3 dB.  
Audio Input  
Setting for audio  
inputs  
TRIM CH-2  
Finely adjust the sensitivity of channel 2 of external  
–8 dBu to –65 dBu (–41 dBu) microphone input in steps of 3 dB.  
AGC Link  
Linked / Separated  
Select the gain link condition when the audio level adjustment  
is in AGC mode.  
Linked: To vary the CH-1 gain and the CH-2 gain in  
synchronization.  
Separated: To vary the CH-1 gain and the CH-2 gain  
independently according to the respective levels.  
1KHz Tone  
On / Off  
Turn the 1-kHz reference tone signal on/off.  
Turn the wind filter for channel 1 on/off.  
Turn the wind filter for channel 2 on/off.  
Wind Filter CH-1  
On / Off  
Wind Filter CH-2  
On / Off  
EXT CH Select  
CH-1  
CH-1: To record channel 1 audio input on both channels 1  
and 2.  
CH-1/CH-2  
CH-1/CH-2: To record channel 1 and channel 2 inputs on the  
respective channels.  
Monitor CH  
Select the audio channel(s) to be fed to the headphones and  
the built-in speaker.  
CH-1/CH-2 (CH-3/CH-4): Stereo  
CH-1+CH-2 (CH-3+CH-4): Mix  
CH-1 (CH-3): CH-1 (CH-3) only  
CH-2 (CH-4): CH-2 (CH-4) only  
Audio Output  
Setting for audio  
outputs  
CH-1/CH-2 (CH-3/CH-4)  
CH-1+CH-2 (CH-3+CH-4)  
CH-1 (CH-3)  
CH-2 (CH-4)  
(
): with Output CH set to “CH-3/CH-4”  
Output CH  
CH-1/CH-2  
CH-3/CH-4  
Select audio output channels from either channels 1 and 2 or  
channels 3 and 4.  
Alarm Level  
Set the alarm sound volume.  
0 to 10 (5)  
Beep  
Select whether or not to sound a beep upon each operation.  
On / Off  
Setup Menu List  
102  
       
VIDEO SET Menu  
VIDEO SET  
Menu items  
Setting values  
Contents  
HD / SD/ Off  
Select the output signal from the COMPONENT OUT  
connector and the SDI OUT connector.  
HD: To output the same HD signal as that in recording and  
playback  
SD: To output a down-converted SD signal  
Off: No output  
YPbPr/SDI Out  
Select  
Setting the  
component/SDI  
outputs  
Note  
When using the A/V OUT connector, select “Off.” Otherwise,  
no signal is fed out from the A/V OUT connector.  
On / Off  
Set whether to add the same menus and status indications as  
those on the LCD monitor/EVF screen to the output signals  
from the COMPONENT OUT connector and the SDI OUT  
connector.  
YPbPr/SDI Out  
Display  
Setting the  
character  
information for the  
component/SDI  
outputs  
Note  
On the thumbnail, EXPAND CLIP and SHOTMARK screens,  
the same menus and status indications as those on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen are displayed regardless of the setting of  
this item.  
On / Off  
Set whether to add the same menus and status indications as  
those on the LCD monitor/EVF screen to the output signal  
from the A/V OUT connector.  
Video Out  
Display  
Setting the  
character  
information for the  
composite output  
Note  
On the thumbnail, EXPAND CLIP and SHOTMARK screens,  
the same menus and status indications as those on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen are displayed regardless of the setting of  
this item.  
Set whether to add 7.5% setup to the output signal from the  
A/V OUT connector when a format of NTSC is selected  
(Invalid when a format of PAL is selected).  
Setup  
On / Off  
Setting 7.5% setup  
for the composite  
signal  
Note  
The default setting is different among the sales areas.  
United States and Canada: On  
Other areas: Off  
Squeeze / Letterbox / Edge  
Crop  
Set the output mode (aspect) for SD output from the A/V  
OUT, COMPONENT OUT, and SDI OUT connectors.  
Squeeze: To horizontally reduce a 16:9 picture to output a 4:3  
picture  
Letterbox: To mask the upper and lower areas of a 4:3 picture  
to display a 16:9 picture in the center of the screen  
Edge Crop: To cut the both sides of a 16:9 picture to output a  
4:3 picture  
Down  
Converter  
Selecting the  
operation mode of  
the down converter  
Setup Menu List  
103  
             
LCD/VF SET Menu  
LCD/VF SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Color  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Contrast  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Brightness  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Backlight  
High / Low  
Mode  
Color / B&W  
Adjust the color of pictures on the LCD monitor.  
Adjust the contrast of pictures on the LCD monitor.  
Adjust the brightness of pictures on the LCD monitor.  
Select the brightness of the EVF backlight.  
LCD  
Adjusting the LCD  
monitor  
EVF  
Setting the  
viewfinder  
Select the display mode of the EVF.  
Color: Color mode  
B&W: Monochrome mode  
Contrast  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Brightness  
–99 to +99 ( 0)  
Power  
Auto / On  
Adjust the contrast of pictures on the EVF screen.  
Adjust the brightness of pictures on the EVF screen.  
Set the condition to turn the EVF on.  
Auto: To turn it on when the LCD monitor is closed or rotated  
to the upside-down position.  
On: To keep it on regardless of the status of the LCD monitor  
Color  
White / Red / Yellow / Blue  
Level  
High / Mid / Low  
Setting  
On / Off  
Select the color of the peaking signal.  
Set the level of the peaking signal.  
Peaking  
Setting the peaking  
function for the  
LCD monitor/EVF  
Turn all marker indications on/off in combination.  
Turn the safety marker on/off.  
Marker  
Setting the  
markers added to  
pictures on the  
LCD monitor/EVF  
screen  
Safety Zone  
On / Off  
Safety Area  
80% / 90% / 92.5% / 95%  
Select the size (ratio to the entire screen) of the safety zone  
marker.  
Center Marker  
Turn the center marker on/off.  
On / Off  
Aspect Marker  
On / Off  
Turn the aspect marker on/off.  
Select the type of the aspect marker.  
Turn the guide frame marker on/off.  
Aspect Select  
4:3 / 13:9 / 14:9 / 15:9  
Guide Frame  
On / Off  
Zebra Select  
1 / 2 / Both  
Select the zebra pattern(s) to be displayed.  
1: To display zebra 1 only  
Zebra  
Setting the zebra  
2: To display zebra 2 only  
pattern  
Both: To display both zebra 1 and zebra 2.  
Zebra1 Level  
Set the display level of zebra 1.  
50 to 107 (70)  
Setup Menu List  
104  
             
LCD/VF SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Video Level Warnings  
On / Off  
Turn the warning indication to be displayed when the picture  
is too bright or too dark on/off.  
Display On/Off  
Selecting the items  
to be displayed on  
the LCD monitor/  
EVF screen  
Brightness Display  
On / Off  
Turn the numeric indication to show the picture brightness on/  
off.  
Histogram  
On / Off  
Turn the histogram indication to show the level distribution of  
the picture on/off.  
Lens Info  
Meter / Feet / Off  
Select the depth-of-field indication.  
Meter: To indicate in meters  
Feet: To indicate in feet  
Off: To not indicate  
Zoom Position  
Number / Bar / Off  
Select the type of zoom position indication.  
Number: Indication with a number  
Bar: Indication with a bar  
Off: To not display  
Audio Level Meter  
Turn the audio level meter indication on/off.  
On / Off  
Timecode  
On / Off  
Turn the time data (timecode, user bits, duration) indication  
on/off.  
Rec Status  
On / Off  
Turn the recording status (REC or STBY) and media status  
indications on/off.  
Battery Remain  
On / Off  
Turn the battery remaining/DC input voltage indication on/  
off.  
Media Remain  
Turn the media remaining indication on/off.  
On / Off  
TLCS Mode  
Turn the TLCS mode indication on/off.  
On / Off  
Steady Shot  
Turn the Steady Shot indication on/off.  
On / Off  
Focus Mode  
On / Off  
Turn the focus operation mode indication on/off.  
Turn the white balance mode indication on/off.  
Turn the Picture Profile indication on/off.  
Turn the ND filter setting indication on/off.  
Turn the iris setting indication on/off.  
White Balance Mode  
On / Off  
Picture Profile  
On / Off  
Filter Position  
On / Off  
Iris Position  
On / Off  
Gain Setting  
Turn the gain setting indication on/off.  
On / Off  
Shutter Setting  
On / Off  
Turn the shutter mode and speed indication on/off.  
Turn the fader operation mode indication on/off.  
Fader Status  
On / Off  
Rec Mode  
On / Off  
Turn the special recording mode (Frame Rec, Interval Rec,  
S&Q Motion) indication on/off.  
Video Format  
Turn the video format indication on/off.  
On / Off  
Setup Menu List  
105  
 
TC/UB SET Menu  
TC/UB SET  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Mode  
Preset / Regen / Clock  
Set the timecode mode.  
Timecode  
Setting the  
timecode  
Preset: To start the timecode from the specified value  
Regen (regeneration): To continue the timecode from that of  
the previous clip  
Clock: To use the current clock time as the timecode  
Run  
Rec Run / Free Run  
Set the running mode when the timecode mode is set to  
“Preset.”  
Rec Run: The timecode advances only in recording mode.  
Free Run: The timecode keeps advancing regardless of  
recording.  
Setting  
Reset  
Set the timecode to a desired value.  
Select “SET” to finish the setting.  
Select “Execute” to reset the timecode to 00:00:00:00.  
Execute / Cancel  
Mode  
Fix / Date  
Set the user bit mode.  
Fix: To use a desired fixed value as the user bits  
Date: To use the current date  
Users Bit  
Setting the user  
bits  
Setting  
DF / NDF  
Set the user bits to a desired value.  
Set the timecode format.  
DF: Drop frame  
NDF: Non drop frame  
TC Format  
Setting the time  
code format  
OTHERS Menu  
OTHERS  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Execute/Cancel Select “Execute” to reset the camcorder to the factory status.  
All Reset  
Resetting to the  
factory status  
Store  
Execute/Cancel  
Recall  
Select “Execute” to store the setting values in an SxS memory  
card.  
Camera Data  
Storing/recalling  
the menu settings  
Select “Execute” to retrieve the setting values from an SxS  
memory card.  
Execute/Cancel  
Set the time-zone difference from UTC in steps of 30  
minutes.  
Time Zone  
Setting the time  
difference  
UTC –12:00 to +14:00  
Note  
The default setting is different among the sales areas.  
United States and Canada: –5:00  
Europe area: 0:00  
Oceania: +10:00  
Setup Menu List  
106  
                   
OTHERS  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Date/Time  
Set the current time and date.  
Clock Set  
Setting the built-in  
clock  
12H/24H  
12H / 24H  
Select the display mode of time.  
12H: 12-hour mode  
24H: 24-hour mode  
Date Mode  
YYMMDD / MMDDYY /  
DDMMYY  
Select the display mode of the date.  
YYMMDD: In sequence of year, month, day  
MMDDYY: In sequence of month, day, year  
DDMMYY: In sequence of day, month, year  
English / Chinese / Japanese  
English: To display the messages in English  
Chinese: To display the messages in Chinese  
Japanese: To display the messages in Japaneses  
Language  
Selecting the  
language for  
messages  
Note  
This setting is effective only on messages for warning and  
caution. The menus and status indications do not change.  
<1>  
Assign a function to the ASSIGN button of the corresponding  
Assign Button  
Assigning  
Off / Marker / Last Clip DEL / number.  
ATW / Rec Review / Rec /  
Freeze Mix / Expanded Focus / Marker: For turning the markers on/off  
The selectable functions are common.  
functions to the  
assignable buttons  
Spotlight / Backlight / IR  
Remote / Shot Mark1 / Shot  
Mark2 / Fader / EVF Mode /  
Last Clip DEL: For deleting the last recorded clip  
ATW: For turning ATW on/off  
Rec Review: For starting a Rec Review  
BRT Disp / Histogram / Lens Rec: For starting/stopping recording  
Info  
Freeze Mix: For executing Freeze Mix  
Expanded Focus: For turning Expanded Focus on/off  
Spotlight: For selecting TLCS Spotlight mode  
Backlight: For selecting TLCS Backlight mode  
IR Remote: For activating/deactivating the IR Remote  
Commander  
<2>  
Off / Marker / Last Clip DEL /  
ATW / Rec Review / Rec /  
Freeze Mix / Expanded Focus /  
Spotlight / Backlight / IR  
Remote / Shot Mark1 / Shot  
Mark2 / Fader / EVF Mode /  
BRT Disp / Histogram / Lens  
Info  
Shot Mark1: For adding shot mark 1  
Shot Mark2: For adding shot mark 2  
Fader: For turning the Fader function on/off  
EVF Mode: For switching between color and monochrome  
modes of the EVF  
BRT Disp: For turning the brightness level indication on/off  
Histogram: For turning the histogram indication on/off  
Lens Info: For turning the depth-of-field indication on/off  
Off: No function  
<3>  
Off / Marker / Last Clip DEL /  
ATW / Rec Review / Rec /  
Freeze Mix / Expanded Focus /  
Spotlight / Backlight / IR  
Remote / Shot Mark1 / Shot  
Mark2 / Fader / EVF Mode /  
BRT Disp / Histogram / Lens  
Info  
<4>  
Off / Marker / Last Clip DEL /  
ATW / Rec Review / Rec /  
Freeze Mix / Expanded Focus /  
Spotlight / Backlight / IR  
Remote / Shot Mark1 / Shot  
Mark2 / Fader / EVF Mode /  
BRT Disp / Histogram / Lens  
Info  
Setup Menu List  
107  
     
OTHERS  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Front Set the brightness of the tally lamp on the front.  
High / Low / Off  
Tally  
Setting the tally  
lamps  
High: To brighten the lamp  
Low: To dim the lamp  
Off: To not light the lamp  
Rear  
On / Off  
Turn the tally lamp on the rear on/off.  
Hours (Sys)  
The non-resettable accumulated time of use is displayed.  
The resettable accumulated time of use is displayed.  
Select “Execute” to reset the Hours (Reset) value to 0.  
Hours Meter  
Displaying the  
hours meter  
Hours (Reset)  
Reset  
Execute/Cancel  
On / Off  
Set to “On” to activate remote control operations from the  
supplied IR Remote Commander.  
IR Remote  
Activating/  
deactivating the  
Remote  
Note  
The setting automatically returns to “Off” when the  
camcorder is turned off.  
Commander  
Low BATT  
5% / 10% / 15% / ... / 45% /  
50%  
Set the battery level at which the Low BATT warning is  
generated (in steps of 5%).  
Battery Alarm  
Setting the low  
power alarm  
BATT Empty  
3% to 7% (3%)  
Set the battery level at which the BATT Empty warning is  
generated.  
DC Low Volt1  
11.5 V to 17.0 V (11.5 V)  
Set the DC IN voltage at which the DC Low Volt1 warning is  
generated.  
DC Low Volt2  
11.0 V to 14.0 V (11.0 V)  
Set the DC IN voltage at which the DC Low Volt2 warning is  
generated.  
Type  
The type (product name) is displayed.  
The date of manufacture is displayed.  
Battery INFO  
Showing  
information  
regarding the  
battery pack  
(display only)  
MFG Date  
Charge Count  
The accumulated number of times of charge/discharge is  
displayed.  
Capacity  
The estimated total capacity of full charge is displayed.  
The current output voltage is displayed.  
Voltage  
Remaining  
All / Part / Off  
The current remaining level is displayed.  
All: All Direct menu operations are permitted.  
Part: A part of Direct menu operations is permitted. The  
operation is limited depending on the GAIN, SHUTTER,  
or WHITE BAL switch setting.  
Direct Menu  
Setting the Direct  
menu function  
Off: No Direct menu operation is permitted.  
Enable / Disable  
Enable: To use the i.LINK connector  
i.LINK I/O  
Disable: To not use the i.LINK connector  
Setting for input/  
output at the  
i.LINK connector  
Notes  
• When you set this item to “Enable,” no signal is fed out  
from the SDI OUT connector.  
• When the video format is not SP mode, signal input/output  
via the i.LINK connector is not enabled, even if this item is  
set to “Enable.”  
Setup Menu List  
108  
             
OTHERS  
Menu items  
Subitems and setting values Contents  
Internal / Both / External  
Internal: To activate recording start/stop operations only for  
an SxS memory card in a built-in slot.  
Trigger Mode  
Setting whether to  
trigger recording  
start/stop for an  
external device  
connected to via  
the i.LINK  
Both: To activate recording start/stop operations both for an  
SxS memory card in a built-in slot and the external  
recording device connected via the i.LINK connector.  
External: To activate recording start/stop operations only for  
the external recording device connected via the i.LINK  
connector.  
connector  
Select the color system for the area where you will use the  
camcorder.  
Country  
Setting the area for  
use  
NTSC Area / PAL Area  
Note  
The default setting is different among the sales areas.  
United States and Canada: NTSC  
Other areas: PAL  
3)  
Select the video format (bit rate, picture size, frame rate, and  
scan system in combination).  
• Bit rate  
Video Format  
Country: NTSC Area  
HQ 1080/60i  
SP 1080/60i  
Selecting the video  
format  
HQ or SP  
• Picture size  
1080 or 720  
• Frame rate  
HQ 1080/30P  
HQ 1080/24P  
SP 1080/24P  
HQ 720/60P  
24, 25, 30, 50, or 60  
• Scan system  
HQ 720/30P  
HQ 720/24P  
i (interlace) or P (progressive)  
Country: PAL Area  
HQ 1080/50i  
SP 1080/50i  
Note  
The default setting is different among the sales areas.  
United States and Canada: HQ 1080/60i  
Other areas: HQ 1080/50i  
HQ 1080/25P  
HQ 720/50P  
HQ 720/25P  
Title Prefix  
nnn_  
(nnn=least three digits of the  
serial number)  
Set the first 4-alphanumeric part of the clip names.  
You can use upper- and lowercase alphabets, numerics 0 to 9,  
- (hyphen), and _ (underscore).  
Clip  
Setting for clip  
name or deletion  
Number Reset  
Execute / Cancel  
Select “Execute” to reset the second 4-numeric part of the clip  
name to 0001.  
Last Clip DEL  
Select “Execute” to delete the last recorded clip.  
Execute / Cancel  
All Clips DEL  
Execute / Cancel  
Select “Execute” to delete all clips on the active SxS memory  
card.  
Note  
Clips to which you applied OK mark cannot be deleted.  
Select “Execute” to format the SxS memory card in slot A.  
Media (A)  
Execute / Cancel  
Format Media  
Formatting SxS  
memory cards  
Media (B)  
Select “Execute” to format the SxS memory card in slot B.  
Execute / Cancel  
Setup Menu List  
109  
         
Connecting External Devices  
Connecting External Monitors  
To display recording/playback pictures on an  
external monitor, select the output signal and use  
an appropriate cable for the monitor to be  
connected.  
When outputting SD signals, select in advance the  
output mode (Squeeze, Letterbox, or Edge Crop)  
with “Down Converter” of the VIDEO SET  
menu.  
Note  
SD signals down-converted for output have the  
following restrictions:  
M
O
N
IT  
T
OR  
H
U
V
O
M
B
L
N
A
IL  
S
E
L/  
S
ET  
F
R
E
C
A
V
P
N
C
LA  
Y
EL  
j
/P  
AU  
S
E
P
F
F
W
D
R
E
/S  
V
S
J
l
TO  
P
s
N
E
X
T
L
S
T
A
R
E
T
C
/S  
TO  
R
P
H
H
O
L
O
L
F
D
F
-2  
Images of 50P/50i/25P are output as PAL signals,  
those of 59.94P/59.94i/29.97P are output as  
NTSC signals, and those of 23.98P are output as  
2-3 pulled-down NTSC signals.  
CH  
IN  
O
U
DI  
A
-1  
CH  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
MIC  
MIC+48V  
LINE  
R
E
LE  
A
S
E
R
T
N
S
H
O
A
A
S
T
T
I
O
I
O
N
B
N
O
B
F F  
G
I
H
L .  
T
T T A B  
D
I
F
N
I
Y
L
P S  
R U D  
B -  
C
T
O
A
I
/
T
A
T
I
U
/
S
R
A B  
N
O
M
A
C
/
U
T
A
T
S
S
S
E
L/  
S
E
T
C
A
N
C
E
L
C
A
M
O
E
FF  
R
A
M
E
D
IA  
C
C
H
H
-1  
-2  
P
IC  
TU  
P
R
A
M
U
AN  
TO  
R
E
O
FI  
UA  
LE  
L
I
D
C
NT  
T
IN  
AU  
D
IO  
EX  
S
E
LE  
C
T
A
U
IN  
D
IO  
A
M
U
TO  
AN  
T
N
UA  
NE  
O
T
L
IN  
T
P
U
M
Y
C
O
EX  
A
TTER  
T
B
O
ASE  
T
U
RELE  
O
/V  
A
P
M
W
-E  
X
1
SDI OUT connector (BNC)  
T
U
O
I
D
S
The connector is set at the factory to output an HD  
SDI signal.  
COMPONENT  
OUT  
A/V OUT  
Using “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” (page 103) of the  
VIDEO SET menu, you can change the setting so  
that it outputs an SD SDI signal. (The HD/SD  
switching becomes valid also on the  
COMPONENT OUT connector in  
synchronization.)  
SDI  
OUT  
A/V OUT  
COMPONENT  
OUT  
Component video  
cable (supplied)  
75-ohm  
coaxial  
cable  
Use a commercially available 75-ohm coaxial  
cable for connection.  
AV  
(optional)  
To display the menus and status information on  
the connected monitor  
Set “YPbPr/SDI Out Display” (page 103) of the  
connection  
cable  
(supplied)  
VIDEO SET menu to “On.”  
Note  
If input/output at the i.LINK (HDV) connector  
are enabled (page 114), no signal is fed out from  
the SDI OUT connector.  
SDI IN  
VIDEO/AUDIO COMPONENT  
IN  
COMPONENT OUT connector (mini-D  
connector)  
The connector is set at the factory to output HD  
analog component signals for monitoring.  
Using “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” (page 103) of the  
VIDEO SET menu, you can change the setting so  
that it outputs down-converted analog component  
signals for monitoring. (The HD/SD switching  
becomes valid also on the SDI OUT connector in  
synchronization.)  
Regardless of whether the signal is HD or SD, the  
same status information and menus can be  
displayed on the external monitor as those on the  
LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
According to the signal fed to the monitor, set  
“YPbPr/SDI Out Display” or “Video Out  
Display” of the VIDEO SET menu (page 103) to  
“On.”  
Use the supplied component video cable for  
connection.  
Connecting External Monitors  
110  
           
To display the menus and status information on  
the connected monitor  
Set “YPbPr/SDI Out Display”(page 103)of the  
Operating Clips With a  
Computer  
VIDEO SET menu to “On.”  
A/V OUT connector (audio/video  
composite multiconnector)  
The clips recorded on SxS memory cards with  
this camcorder can be controlled on a computer or  
edited using the optional nonlinear editing  
software.  
For these purposes, the clips on an SxS memory  
card can be operated by directly loading the card  
in a computer or by connecting the camcorder or  
the optional SBAC-US10 SxS Memory Card  
USB Reader/Writer to the computer, using an  
USB cable as shown below.  
When “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” (page 103) of the  
VIDEO SET menu is set to “Off,” the connector  
outputs 2-channel audio, down-converted SD  
analog composite, and YC separate signals, all for  
monitoring.  
Use the supplied AV connection cable for  
connection.  
To display the menus and status information on  
the connected monitor  
Set “Video Out Display” (page 103) of the  
Preparations  
VIDEO SET menu to “On.”  
To use the ExpressCard slot of a computer  
If the computer is equipped with an ExpressCard/  
34 or ExpressCard/54 slot, you can directly insert  
the SxS memory card containing clips recorded  
with this camcorder and access to the files.  
For the operating requirements for the computer, see  
Note  
The SxS Device Driver Software on the CD-  
ROM supplied with the camcorder must be  
installed on your computer. Before installation,  
be sure to read the enclosed SxS Device Driver  
Software End-User License Agreement.  
For information on installation of the driver, refer to  
the ReadMe on the supplied CD-ROM.  
For support information for the driver, visit the  
following URL:  
http://www.sony.net/SxS-Support/  
to the  
ExpressCard  
slot  
SxS memory card  
Computer with SxS  
Device Driver Software  
installed  
With a Windows computer, check that a  
Removable Disk appears in My Computer. This  
indicates normal status.  
With a Macintosh computer, an icon is displayed  
on the menu bar.  
Operating Clips With a Computer  
111  
         
To connect with a USB cable  
message (e.g., for formatting or restoration of  
an SxS memory card) is shown on the screen.  
It appears when formatting or restoration is  
completed.  
The message is also not displayed while the  
CLIP INFO screen is shown on the screen. It  
appears when an operation on the CLIP  
INFO screen is completed or you return to  
the thumbnail screen.  
When you connect the camcorder or the SBAC-  
US10 SxS Memory Card USB Reader/Writer  
(optional) using the supplied USB cable, the  
memory card in the slot is acknowledged as an  
extended drive by the computer.  
When two memory cards are mounted in this  
camcorder, they are acknowledged as two  
independent extended drives by the computer.  
2
3
Select “Execute” by operating the jog  
dial or the joystick.  
SxS memory card  
The screen displays the following:  
SBAC-US10  
(optional)  
USB cable  
(supplied  
with the  
camcorder)  
USB cable  
(supplied with  
SBAC-US10)  
With Windows, check that the memory  
card is displayed as a removable disk in  
My Computer.  
With Macintosh, check that a “NO  
NAME” or “Untitled” folder was  
created on the desktop.  
This indicates that the connection is active.  
(The folder name on the desktop of the  
Macintosh computer can be changed as  
needed.)  
Notes  
• When connecting the USB cable to the  
computer, be careful to check the form and  
direction of the USB connector.  
• The camcorder and the SBAC-US10 do not  
work on the bus power from the computer.  
Supply the operating power independently.  
Note  
The following operations must be eliminated  
when the access lamp is lit in red.  
• Turning the power off or disconnecting the  
power cord  
• Removing the SxS memory card  
• Disconnecting the USB cable  
To check the connection to the camcorder  
When using the SBAC-US10, refer to the operating  
instructions of the SBAC-US10.  
1
Turn the camcorder on by setting the  
power switch to CAMERA or MEDIA.  
A message prompting you to confirm that  
you wish to enable the USB connection is  
displayed on the LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
Removing an SxS memory card  
Windows  
Connect USB Now?  
Execute  
1. Click on the icon of “Safely Remove  
Hardware” on the task bar of the computer.  
C
ancel  
2. Select “Safely remove SxS Memory Card -  
Drive(X:) from the displayed menu.  
Note  
3. Check that the Safe To Remove Hardware  
This message will not be displayed while  
another confirmation message or in-progress  
message appears then remove the card.  
Operating Clips With a Computer  
112  
   
For information on XDCAM Transfer, visit the web  
or on the cover page of the supplied CD-ROM.  
Macintosh  
Drag the SxS memory card icon on the desktop to  
Trash.  
If the SxS memory card icon is located on Finder,  
click on the eject icon on its side.  
Note  
Do not select “Card Power Off” from the SxS  
memory card icon displayed on the menu bar.  
Using the XDCAM EX Clip Browsing  
Software  
To copy clips to the local disk of a computer, the  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software must be  
used.  
Install the XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
on the supplied CD-ROM to your computer.  
Although the data regarding recorded materials  
are stored over multiple files and folders, you can  
easily handle the clips without considering such  
data and directory structure by using the XDCAM  
EX Clip Browsing Software.  
Note  
If you operate, e.g. copy the clips on the SxS  
memory card by using the Explorer (Windows) or  
Finder (Macintosh), the subsidiary data contained  
by the clips may not be maintained. To avoid such  
a problem, use the XDCAM EX Clip Browsing  
Software.  
See page 13 for the operating requirements, and  
refer to the User’s Guide contained in the CD-ROM.  
For support information on the XDCAM EX Clip  
Browsing Software, visit the web sites shown in  
page of the supplied CD-ROM.  
Using a nonlinear editing system  
For a nonlinear editing system, optional editing  
software that corresponds to the recording  
formats used with this camcorder is required.  
Store the clips to be edited on the HDD of your  
computer in advance, using the supplied  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software.  
Some editing software may not operate properly.  
Be sure to confirm before use that it conforms to  
the recording formats used with this camcorder.  
To use Final Cut Pro of Apple Inc.  
It is necessary to convert the clips to files that can  
be edited with the Final Cut Pro, using XDCAM  
Transfer.  
Operating Clips With a Computer  
113  
   
External: To record only on the external  
device  
Connecting an External  
Device (i.LINK  
Connection)  
2
Set the external device to recording  
standby status.  
For operations of the external device, refer to  
the operation manual of that device.  
When an HDV-compatible video format (SP  
1080/60i, SP 1080/50i, or SP 1080/24P) is  
selected, you can record the same images as those  
recorded on the memory card in this camcorder  
on an external device connected to the  
i.LINK(HDV) connector, or record the playback  
picture of the external device on the memory card  
in the camcorder.  
3
4
Set the camcorder to Camera mode by  
setting the power switch to CAMERA.  
Press the REC START/STOP button.  
The external device starts recording in  
synchronization.  
The status of the external device is displayed in  
the i.LINK status indication area (page 19) on the  
LCD monitor/EVF screen.  
Nonlinear editing conforming to the HDV format  
is also enabled.  
Notes  
Indication  
Status of the external device  
In HDV recording standby  
In HDV recording  
• When you set “i.LINK I/O” of the OTHERS  
menu to “Enable,” no signal is output from the  
SDI OUT connector.  
STBY  
HDV  
z
REC HDV  
• When the video format is not SP mode, signal  
input/output via the i.LINK connector is not  
enabled, even if “i.LINK I/O” is set to “Enable.”  
• When a cable is connected to the i.LINK(HDV)  
connector during playback, the display returns  
to the thumbnail screen.  
Notes  
• Operation may be different depending on the  
type of external device.  
• Although there is some time lag from which you  
press the REC START/STOP button until the  
i.LINK status indication changes, the same  
pictures are recorded on the memory card in this  
camcorder and the external device if “Trigger  
Mode” is set to “Both.”  
• Use the i.LINK(HDV) connector only for one-  
to-one i.LINK connection.  
• While you can record shot marks on the  
memory card during recording, they are not  
added to the pictures recorded on the external  
device.  
Recording the Camcorder Picture  
on an External Device  
When you set the camcorder to Camera mode, the  
picture being shot with this camcorder is output as  
an HDV stream via the i.LINK(HDV) connector.  
It can be recorded on a connected HDV recorder  
in synchronization with the REC START/STOP  
operation on this camcorder.  
Nonlinear Editing  
You can transfer an HDV stream to a nonlinear  
editing system connected via the i.LINK(HDV)  
connector.  
1
Perform the preparatory settings of the  
camcorder.  
Notes  
• The i.LINK(HDV) connector of this camcorder  
is a 4-pin connector. Check the number of pins  
of the i.LINK connector on your computer and  
use an appropriate i.LINK cable.  
• Set the video format to SP 1080/60i, SP  
1080/50i, or SP 1080/24P.  
• Set “i.LINK I/O” (page 108) of the  
OTHERS menu to “Enable.”  
• In searching pictures of this camcorder on the  
computer, it may take some time until the  
display is reflected on the computer.  
• Set “Trigger Mode” (page 109) of the  
OTHERS menu to “Both” or “External.”  
Both: To record both on the memory card  
in the camcorder and on the external device  
Connecting an External Device (i.LINK Connection)  
114  
           
• If the playback clip is short or the playback  
starting point is near the end of the clip, the  
i.LINK signal may be interrupted between the  
clip and the next clip. When you try to capture  
such a signal using the nonlinear editing system,  
a malfunction may occur, depending on the  
nonlinear editing software in use.  
• If you specify a search speed other than 4 or 15  
times normal with the nonlinear editing system,  
no i.LINK signal is fed out. In such a case, the  
picture on the LCD monitor may stay frozen.  
• High-speed playback picture may not be  
displayed on the computer screen, depending on  
the nonlinear editing software in use.  
The audio signal is output from the built-in  
speaker (or headphones connected to the  
headphone jack) and the speaker of the  
monitor connected to the A/V OUT  
connector.  
5
Press the REC START/STOP button on  
the handle.  
Recording begins.  
Notes  
• The REC START/STOP button on the grip does  
not function.  
• An error is generated in the following cases. In  
such a case, cancel Recording mode by pressing  
the REC START/STOP button.  
—The video format of input signal does not  
match that specified on the camcorder.  
—A copy-protected stream is being fed in.  
• If the input to the camcorder becomes no signal  
during recording, the tally lamps and the  
i.LINK zREC status indication on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen flash, indicating that no  
signal is being recorded on the SxS memory  
card.  
Setting on this camcorder  
Set “i.LINK I/O” of the OTHERS menu to  
“Enable.”  
For operations of the nonlinear editing software,  
refer to the operation manual of the software.  
Recording External Input Signals  
The HDV stream input from a device connected  
via the i.LINK connector can be recorded on an  
SxS memory card in this camcorder.  
The timecodes superimposed on the i.LINK input  
are recorded regardless of the settings of the  
camcorder.  
When an input signal is resumed, recording is  
restarted, incrementing the clip number on the  
memory card.  
1
Set the external signal to a format that  
can be recorded on the camcorder.  
Signals of 1440 × 1080/59.94i can be  
recorded when “Video Format” (page 109) is  
set to SP 1080/60i or SP1080/24P. Signals of  
1440 × 1080/50i can be recorded when set to  
SP 1080/50i.  
Recording is not allowed with other  
combinations of “Video Format” and input  
signals.  
2
Set “i.LINK I/O” (page 108) of the  
OTHERS menu to “Enable.”  
3
4
Set the camcorder to Media mode.  
Press the STOP button to set the  
camcorder to STOP mode.  
The input image is displayed on the LCD  
monitor/EVF screen and the monitor  
connected via the COMPONENT OUT  
connector or A/V OUT connector.  
Connecting an External Device (i.LINK Connection)  
115  
 
Appendixes  
Important Notes on Operation  
Use and Storage  
Do not subject the unit to severe shocks  
The internal mechanism may be damaged or the  
body warped.  
Viewfinder release  
lever  
Do not cover the unit while operating  
Putting a cloth, for example, over the unit can  
cause excessive internal heat build-up.  
H
L
F
F
O
After use  
A
Always set the power switch to OFF.  
In the event of operating problems  
If you should experience problems with the unit,  
contact your Sony dealer.  
Before storing the unit for a long period  
Remove the battery pack.  
Grip the handle when carrying  
Grip the handle to carry. If you carry it by other  
parts, such as the front micrphone block or the  
LCD monitor block, the camcorder may drop,  
causing injury.  
Use and storage locations  
Store in a level, ventilated place. Avoid using or  
storing the unit in the following places:  
• In excessive heat or cold (operating temperature  
range: 0ºC to 40ºC or 32ºF to 104ºF)  
Remember that in summer in warm climates the  
temperature inside a car with the windows  
closed can easily exceed 50ºC (122ºF).  
• In damp or dusty locations  
Do not leave the camcorder with the lenses  
facing the sun  
Direct sunlight can enter through the lenses, be  
focused in the camcorder, and cause fire.  
Shipping  
• Locations where the unit may be exposed to rain  
• Locations subject to violent vibration  
• Near strong magnetic fields  
• Remove the memory cards before transporting  
the unit.  
• If sending the unit by truck, ship, air or other  
transportation service, pack it in the shipping  
carton of the unit.  
• Close to radio or TV transmitters producing  
strong electromagnetic fields.  
• In direct sunlight or close to heaters for  
extended periods  
Care of the unit  
To prevent electromagnetic interference from  
portable communications devices  
The use of portable telephones and other  
communications devices near this unit can result  
in malfunctions and interference with audio and  
video signals.  
It is recommended that the portable  
communications devices near this unit be  
powered off.  
Remove dust and dirt from the surfaces of the lens  
using a blower.  
If the body of the unit is dirty, clean it with a soft,  
dry cloth. In extreme cases, use a cloth steeped in  
a little neutral detergent, then wipe dry. Do not  
use organic solvents such as alcohol or thinner, as  
these may cause discoloration or other damage to  
the finish of the unit.  
To remove dust from inside the viewfinder  
remove the viewfinder by sliding it while holding  
the viewfinder release lever downward.  
About the LCD panels  
The LCD panels are manufactured with  
extremely high-precision technology that yields  
Important Notes on Operation  
116  
     
effective pixel rates of 99.99% or higher.  
However, very rarely, one or more  
pixels may be permanently dark or permanently  
lit in white, red, blue, or green.  
The luminance at the top and bottom of the screen  
may change when shooting a flashlight or a light  
source that quickly flashes.  
This phenomenon is not a malfunction. Such  
pixels have no effect on the recorded data, and the  
unit may be used with confidence even if they are  
present.  
Phenomena specific to CMOS image  
sensors  
The following phenomena that may appear in  
images are specific to CMOS (Complementary  
Metal Oxide Semiconductor) image sensors.  
They do not indicate malfunctions.  
White flecks  
Although the CMOS image sensors are produced  
with high-precision technologies, fine white  
flecks may be generated on the screen in rare  
cases, caused by cosmic rays, etc.  
This is related to the principle of CMOS image  
sensors and is not a malfunction.  
The white flecks especially tend to be seen in the  
following cases:  
• when operating at a high environmental  
temperature  
• when you have raised the master gain  
(sensitivity)  
• when operating in Slow-Shutter mode  
Aliasing  
When fine patterns, stripes, or lines are shot, they  
may appear jagged or flicker.  
Flicker  
If recording is made under lighting produced by  
discharge tubes, such as fluorescent, sodium, or  
mercury-vapor lamps, the screen may flicker,  
colors may vary, or horizontal stripes may appear  
distorted. In such cases, turn the Flicker-  
Reduction function on (see page 51).  
In some cases, such phenomena may not be  
improved with the Flicker-Reduction function.  
It is recommend to set the electronic shutter speed  
1
1
to /  
sec. in 50-Hz areas and to / in 60-Hz  
60  
100  
areas.  
Focal plane  
Owing to the characteristics of the pickup  
elements (CMOS sensors) for reading video  
signals, subjects that quickly move across the  
screen may appear slightly skewed.  
Important Notes on Operation  
117  
 
Output formats in clip playback mode  
(Media mode)  
Formats and Limitations  
of Outputs  
Analog component signals from the  
COMPONENT OUT connector are output in the  
format shown below according to the video  
format of the playback clip and the “YPbPr/SDI  
Out Select” setting (HD or SD) of the VIDEO  
SET menu.  
Video Formats and Output  
Formats  
The SDI OUT connector outputs serial digital  
signals of the same format as that of the analog  
component signals fed from the COMPONENT  
OUT connector.  
The format of output signals from the  
COMPONENT OUT connector and the SDI  
OUT connector varies according to the recording/  
playback video formats and the kind of the output  
signal (the setting of “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” of  
the VIDEO SET menu).  
Note  
No signal is output from the A/V OUT connector  
when “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” of the VIDEO  
SET menu is set to “HD” or “SD.”  
1)  
Output formats in E-E mode /recording  
mode (Camera mode)  
When the frame rate setting of the video format  
is 59.94i/59.94P/29.97P/23.98P  
Analog component signals from the  
COMPONENT OUT connector are output in the  
format shown below according to the “Video  
Format” setting of the OTHERS menu and the  
“YPbPr/SDI Out Select” setting (HD or SD) of  
the VIDEO SET menu.  
The SDI OUT connector outputs serial digital  
signals of the same format as that of the analog  
component signals fed from the COMPONENT  
OUT connector.  
Clip format  
Output format  
YPbPr Out  
YPbPr Out  
Select: SD  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i1)  
Select: HD  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97PsF  
1080/59.94i  
720/59.94P  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97P  
1080/23.98P  
720/59.94P  
720/29.97P  
720/23.98P  
1080/50i  
720/59.94P  
720/59.94P  
1080/59.94i1), 2)  
1)E-E mode: Recording standby status  
1), 2)  
1)  
1080/25P  
1080/29.97PsF  
720/59.94P1), 2)  
720/59.94P1), 2)  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i1)  
480/59.94i1)  
Note  
720/50P  
No signal is output from the A/V OUT connector  
when “YPbPr/SDI Out Select” of the VIDEO  
SET menu is set to “HD” or “SD.”  
720/25P  
1)No signal is fed from the SDI OUT connector.  
2)The actual frame rate of the output signal is 1.001  
times of the value shown in the table. Some frame may  
be repeated when converting the frame rate.  
Video  
Output format  
format  
YPbPr Out  
YPbPr Out  
Select: SD  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
576/50i  
Select: HD  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97PsF  
1080/59.94i  
720/59.94P  
720/59.94P  
720/59.94P  
1080/50i  
When the frame rate setting of the video format  
is 50i/50P/25P  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97P  
1080/23.98P  
720/59.94P  
720/29.97P  
720/23.98P  
1080/50i  
Clip format  
Output format  
YPbPr Out  
Select: HD  
1080/50i1), 2)  
YPbPr Out  
Select: SD  
576/50i1)  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97P  
1080/23.98P  
720/59.94P  
720/29.97P  
720/23.98P  
1080/50i  
1), 2)  
1)  
1080/25PsF  
1080/50i1), 2)  
720/50P1), 2)  
576/50i  
576/50i1)  
576/50i1)  
1080/25P  
1080/25PsF  
720/50P  
576/50i  
720/50P  
576/50i  
1), 2)  
1)  
720/50P  
576/50i  
720/25P  
720/50P  
576/50i  
720/50P1), 2)  
576/50i1)  
576/50i  
576/50i  
1080/50i  
1080/25P  
1080/25PsF  
Formats and Limitations of Outputs  
118  
       
2)The actual frame rate of the output signal is 1/1.001 of  
the value shown in the table. Some frame may be  
deleted when converting the frame rate.  
Clip format  
Output format  
YPbPr Out  
Select: HD  
720/50P  
YPbPr Out  
Select: SD  
576/50i  
720/50P  
720/25P  
720/50P  
576/50i  
1)No signal is fed from the SDI OUT connector.  
Limitations of Outputs  
The outputs from the camcorder are limited by the VIDEO SET menu settings as follows. These  
limitations are common to Camera mode and Media mode.  
Menu settings i.LINK I/O  
Enable  
Disable  
HD  
Enable  
SD  
Disable  
SD  
Enable  
Off  
Disable  
Off  
YPbPr/SDI Out Select HD  
Outputs from i.LINK(HDV)  
HDV  
No signal HDV  
No signal SD  
SD SD  
No signal HDV  
No signal  
the output  
connectors  
SDI OUT  
No signal HD  
HD HD  
No signal No signal  
No signal No signal  
COMPONENT OUT  
A/V OUT  
No signal No signal No signal No signal SD  
SD  
Formats and Limitations of Outputs  
119  
 
Replacing the backup battery  
Backup Battery  
Notes  
• Be sure to set the power switch to OFF when  
replacing the backup battery.  
• Be careful not to drop the removed screw into  
the camcorder.  
This camcorder uses a backup battery to retain  
various setting data.  
A lithium battery (CR2032) for backup is  
mounted in the camcorder at the factory.  
The backup battery retains the date, time, and  
timecode in Free Run mode even when no  
operating power is being supplied.  
1
Open the cover of the backup battery  
holder on the bottom by loosening the  
screw, and remove the battery.  
Service life of the backup battery  
CR2025  
3V  
When the backup battery’s voltage falls, the  
backup battery low-voltage warning appears on  
the LCD monitor/viewfinder screen.  
If this warning appears, replace the battery as  
soon as possible.  
2
3
Insert a new backup battery (CR2032)  
with the + symbol on the battery facing  
outside.  
WARNING  
Battery may explode if mistreated.  
Do not recharge, disassemble, or dispose of in  
fire.  
CR2025  
3V  
CAUTION  
• Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly  
replaced. Replace only with the same or  
equivalent type recommended by the  
manufacturer.  
Attach the cover in the original position.  
• Dispose of used batteries according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
CR2025  
3V  
ATTENTION  
• Il y a danger d’explosion s’il y a remplacement  
incorrect de la batterie. Remplacer uniquement  
avec une batterie du même type ou d’un type  
équivalent recommandé par le constructeur.  
• Mettre au rebut les batteries usagées  
conformément aux instructions du fabricant.  
VORSICHT  
• Explosionsgefahr bei Verwendung falscher  
Batterien. Batterien nur durch den vom  
Hersteller empfohlenen oder einen  
gleichwertigen Typ ersetzen.  
• Verbrauchte Batterien entsprechend den  
Anweisungen des Herstellers entsorgen.  
Backup Battery  
120  
     
Troubleshooting  
Operating Power  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
The camcorder does not No battery pack is mounted and no Mount a battery pack (page 22) or connect an AC  
power on when you set  
power is supplied to the DC IN  
power using the BC-U1(page 23) .  
the power switch either to connector.  
CAMERA or MEDIA.  
The battery pack is completely  
Replace the battery pack with a fully charged one  
exhausted.  
The power supply cuts  
while operating.  
The battery pack becomes exhausted. Replace the battery pack with a fully charged one  
The battery pack becomes The ambient temperature is very low. This owes to the battery characteristics and is not a  
exhausted very quickly.  
defect.  
The battery pack is inadequately  
charged.  
Recharge the battery pack (page 22).  
If the battery pack is soon exhausted even after you  
charged it fully, it may comes to the end of its life.  
Replace it with a new one.  
Recording/Playback  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
Recording does not start The power switch is set to OFF or  
when you press the REC MEDIA.  
Set the power switch to CAMERA.  
START/STOP button.  
The SxS memory card is write-  
Release the write protection (page 30), or replace the  
protected.  
card with a non-protected SxS memory card.  
The SxS memory card is full.  
Replace the card with one having sufficient space.  
The SxS memory card needs  
restoration.  
Restore the memory card (page 33).  
Playback does not start  
The power switch is set to OFF or  
Set the power switch to MEDIA.  
when you press the PLAY CAMERA.  
button.  
The supplied IR Remote Remote control operation is disabled. Enable remote control operation (page 28).  
Commander does not  
work.  
The battery of the IR Remote  
Commander is exhausted.  
Replace the battery with a new one.  
Audio recording is not  
possible.  
The AUDIO LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) Adjust the audio recording levels with the AUDIO  
controls are set to the minimum level. LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls (page 55).  
The recorded sound is  
distorted.  
The audio level is too high.  
Adjust the audio recording levels with the AUDIO  
LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls (page 55), and record  
again.  
The recorded sound has a The audio level is too low.  
high noise level.  
Adjust the audio recording levels with the AUDIO  
LEVEL (CH-1/CH-2) controls (page 55), and record  
again.  
Troubleshooting  
121  
       
External Devices  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
The equipment connected It sometimes takes time for the  
to the camcorder via an connected equipment to recognize  
Wait for about 15 seconds. If the connected  
equipment still does not react, do the following:  
i.LINK connection does the operation.  
not react as expected, for  
example, no picture  
Check the i.LINK cable, for example, by re-  
plugging it.  
• Turn the power off, and connect the cable again.  
• Change the i.LINK cable.  
appears on its screen.  
Troubleshooting  
122  
 
Error/Warning Indications  
The camcorder informs you of situations where  
warning, caution, or an operation check is  
required, through messages on the LCD monitor/  
EVF screen, the tally lamps, and a buzzer.  
The buzzer is output to the built-in speaker or to  
the headphones connected via the headphone  
connector. The buzzer volume can be adjusted  
with “Alarm Level” in “Audio Output” of the  
AUDIO SET menu.  
Error Indications  
The camcorder stops operation after the following indications.  
Error indication on Buzzer  
LCD/EVF  
Tally  
lamps  
Cause and measures  
E + Error code  
Continuous Rapidly  
flashing  
The camcorder may be defective.  
Turn off the power and consult Sony service personnel.  
(If power cannot be turned off by setting the power switch to  
OFF, remove both the battery pack and the DC IN source.)  
Warning Indications  
When one of the following indications is generated, follow the message to clear the problem.  
Warning indication Buzzer  
on LCD/EVF  
Tally  
lamps  
Cause and measures  
Media Near Full  
Intermittent Flashing  
Free space on the SxS memory card has become insufficient.  
Replace it with another at the earliest opportunity.  
No space is left on the SxS memory card. Recording, clip  
copying and clip division cannot be performed.  
Replace it with another.  
Media Full  
Continuous Rapidly  
flashing  
Battery Near End  
Battery End  
Intermittent Flashing  
The battery power will be exhausted soon.  
Charge the battery pack at the earliest opportunity.  
The battery pack is exhausted. Recording cannot be  
performed.  
Continuous Rapidly  
flashing  
Connect a power source via the DC IN connector or stop  
operation to charge the battery pack.  
The internal temperature has risen above a safe operation  
limit.  
Temperature High  
Intermittent Flashing  
Suspend operation, turn off the power, and wait until the  
temperature falls.  
Voltage Low  
Intermittent Flashing  
The DC IN voltage has become low (stage 1).  
Check the power supply.  
Insufficient Voltage  
Continuous Rapidly  
flashing  
The DC IN voltage is too low (stage 2). Recording cannot be  
performed.  
Connect other power source.  
Battery Error  
An error was detected with the battery pack.  
Replace the battery pack with a normal one.  
The remaining power of the backup battery is insufficient.  
Replace the battery with a new one.  
Please Change Battery.  
Backup Battery End  
Please Change.  
Error/Warning Indications  
123  
               
Warning indication Buzzer  
on LCD/EVF  
Tally  
lamps  
Cause and measures  
1)  
A partitioned memory card or one that contains recorded clips  
exceeding the number permitted with this camcorder is loaded.  
This card cannot be used with this camcorder. Remove it and  
load a compatible card.  
Unknown Media(A)  
Please Change.  
Media Error  
An error occurred with the memory card. The card requires  
restoration.  
1)  
Media(A) Needs to be  
Remove the card, load it again, and restore it.  
Restored  
Media Error  
Cannot Record to  
Recording cannot be done, as the memory card is defective.  
As playback may be possible, it is recommended to replace it  
with another card after copying the clips, as required.  
1)  
Media(A)  
Media Error  
Neither recording nor playback can be done, as the memory  
card is defective.  
1)  
Cannot Use Media(A)  
It cannot be operated with this camcorder. Replace it with  
another card.  
Video Format Mismatch  
The external signal input via the i.LINK connection cannot be  
recorded, as the Video Format setting is different from the  
signal format of the external input signal.  
Change “Video Format” of the OTHERS menu to match it to  
that of the external signal.  
Copy Protected Input  
Cannot Record  
The external signal input via the i.LINK connection cannot be  
recorded, as the stream is copy-protected.  
Check the input signal.  
Media Error  
Playback Halted  
An error occurred in reading data from the memory card, and  
playback cannot be continued.  
If this frequently occurs, change the memory card after  
copying the clips, as required.  
1)  
Recording cannot be done, as an error occurred with the  
memory card.  
Media(A) Error  
If this frequently occurs, change the memory card.  
1)(B) for the card in slot B  
Error/Warning Indications  
124  
About data transfer speed of i.LINK  
About i.LINK  
i.LINK defines a maximum data transfer speed of  
1)  
approximately 100, 200 and 400 Mbps that are  
described as S100, S200 and S400 respectively.  
For i.LINK devices, a maximum data transfer  
speed that the device supports is identified on  
“Specifications” page of the operating  
instructions supplied with the device or near its  
i.LINK connector.  
This section explains the specifications and  
features of i.LINK.  
What is i.LINK?  
1)When connecting with the device that support  
different data transfer speed, the actual data transfer  
speed may be different from those described on the  
i.LINK connectors.  
i.LINK is a digital serial interface designed to  
integrate devices equipped with i.LINK  
connectors. i.LINK allows your device to:  
• Perform two-way transmission and reception of  
data such as digital audio and digital video  
signals.  
• Control other i.LINK devices.  
• Easily connect multiple devices with a single  
i.LINK cable.  
What is Mbps?  
Mega bits per second. A measure of the rate at  
which data is transmitted per second. In case of  
100 Mbps, 100 Mega bits of data can be  
transmitted per second.  
Your i.LINK device is capable of connecting to a  
wide range of digital AV devices for data transfer  
and other operations.  
Other advantages include the following feature.  
When connected to multiple i.LINK devices,  
your i.LINK device can perform data transfer and  
other operations not only  
with the directly connected devices but also with  
any of the devices that are connected to those  
devices. Therefore, you do not need to be  
concerned with device connection order.  
However, depending on the features and  
specifications of the connected devices, you may  
need to use certain functions differently, and you  
may not be able to transfer data or perform certain  
operations.  
i.LINK operation with your camcorder  
For details on operation when other equipment  
with i.LINK (HDV) connector is connected, see  
For details on connection with i.LINK cable and  
necessary software, refer to the operating  
instructions supplied with the connected device.  
About the required i.LINK cable  
Use the Sony 6-pin-to-4-pin or 4-pin-to-4-pin  
i.LINK cable (for HDV dubbing) to connect the  
i.LINK devices.  
i.LINK and  
are trademarks.  
i.LINK, a nickname for IEEE 1394 proposed by  
Sony, is a trademark supported by many  
companies worldwide.  
IEEE 1394 is an international standard defined by  
IEEE, the Institute of Electrical and Electronics  
Engineers, Inc.  
Note  
The camcorder can be connected to one device  
with the i.LINK cable (DV cable). When you  
connect with a device that has two or more  
i.LINK connectors, refer to the  
operating instructions supplied with the  
connected device.  
About i.LINK  
125  
     
MPEG-2 Video Patent  
Portfolio License  
AVC Patent Portfolio  
License  
PMW-EX1  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
ANY USE OF THIS PRODUCT OTHER THAN  
CONSUMER PERSONAL USE IN ANY  
MANNER THAT COMPLIES WITH THE  
MPEG-2 STANDARD FOR ENCODING  
VIDEO INFORMATION FOR PACKAGED  
MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY PROHIBITED  
WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER  
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE  
AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR  
THE PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL  
USE OF A CONSUMER TO  
(i)ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH  
THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”)  
AND/OR  
APPLICABLE PATENTS IN THE MPEG-2  
PATENT PORTFOLIO, WHICH LICENSE IS  
AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250  
STEELE STREET, SUITE 300, DENVER,  
COLORADO 80206.  
(ii)DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS  
ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN  
A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL  
ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM  
A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO  
PROVIDE AVC VIDEO.  
NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE  
IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE.  
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE  
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE  
HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM  
“PACKAGED MEDIA” means any storage  
media storing MPEG-2 video information such as  
DVD movie which are sold/distributed to general  
consumers. Disc replicators or sellers of the  
PACKAGED MEDIA need to obtain licenses for  
their own business from MPEG LA. Please  
contact MPEG LA for any further information.  
MPEG LA. L.L.C., 250 STEELE STREET,  
SUITE 300, DENVER, COLORADO 80206  
http://www.mpegla.com  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
ANY USE OF THIS PRODUCT OTHER THAN  
CONSUMER PERSONAL USE IN ANY  
MANNER THAT COMPLIES WITH THE  
MPEG-2 STANDARD FOR ENCODING  
VIDEO INFORMATION FOR PACKAGED  
MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY PROHIBITED  
WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER  
APPLICABLE PATENTS IN THE MPEG-2  
PATENT PORTFOLIO, WHICH LICENSE IS  
AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250  
STEELE STREET, SUITE 300, DENVER,  
COLORADO 80206.  
MPEG-2 Video Patent Portfolio License / AVC Patent Portfolio License  
126  
   
VC-1 Patent Portfolio  
License  
Specifications  
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software  
General  
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE  
VC-1 PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR  
THE PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL  
USE OF A CONSUMER TO  
(i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH  
THE VC-1 STANDARD ("VC-1 VIDEO")  
AND/OR  
Power requirements  
DC 12 V  
Power consumption  
Approx. 12 W (Typical) (Recording,  
EVF On, LCD monitor Off)  
(ii) DECODE VC-1 VIDEO THAT WAS  
ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN  
A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL  
ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM  
A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO  
PROVIDE VC-1 VIDEO.  
Peak inrush current  
(1) Power ON, current probe method:  
15 A (240V)  
(2) Hot switching inrush current,  
measured in accordance with  
European standard EN55103-1:  
62 A (230V)  
NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE  
IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE.  
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE  
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE  
HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM  
Operating temperature  
0ºC to +40ºC (32ºF to 104ºF)  
Storage temperature  
–20ºC to +60ºC (–4ºF to 140ºF)  
Recording/playback formats  
Video  
HQ mode: MPEG-2 MP@HL,  
35 Mbps / VBR  
1920 × 1080/59.94i, 50i, 29.97P, 25P,  
23.98P  
1280 × 720/59.94P, 50P, 29.97P, 25P,  
23.98P  
SP mode: MPEG-2 MP@H-14,  
25 Mbps /CBR  
1440 × 1080 /59.94i, 50i  
(23.98P is converted to 59.94i in 2-3  
pull-down processing.)  
Audio  
LPCM (16 bits, 48 kHz, 2 channels)  
Recording/playback time  
With one SBP-8  
SP mode: Approx. 35 min.  
HQ mode: Approx. 25 min.  
With one SBP-16  
SP mode: Approx. 70 min.  
VC-1 Patent Portfolio License / Specifications  
127  
     
HQ mode: Approx. 50 min.  
Continuous operation time  
Filter thread  
M77 mm, pitch 0.75 mm  
(Recording, EVF On, LCD monitor Off)  
Macro  
ON/OFF switchable  
With the BP-U60  
Approx. 4 hours  
With the BP-U30  
Camera  
Approx. 2 hours  
Pickup device  
1
Mass  
/ -inch type, CMOS image sensor  
2
Camcorder: 2.4 kg (5 lb 5 oz)  
Effective picture elements:  
With the supplied lens hood, eyecup,  
BP-U30 battery pack and one SxS  
memory card: 2.8 kg (6 lb 3 oz)  
1920 (H) × 1080 (V)  
Format  
3-chip RGB  
Dimensions  
See page 130.  
Optical system  
F1.6 prism system  
Supplied accessories  
Built-in filters  
ND filters  
See page 9.  
OFF: Clear  
1
1: / ND  
8
Camera Block  
1
2: / ND  
64  
Lens  
Sensitivity  
F10 (Typical) (With 1080/60i, 89.9%  
Focal length  
reflection, 2000 lx)  
5.8 mm to 81.2 mm  
Minimum illumination  
(equivalent to 31.4 mm to 439 mm on  
35 mm lens)  
0.14 lx (F1.9, +18 dB, 64-frame  
accumulation)  
Zoom  
Video S/N  
54 dB (Y) (Typical)  
Servo/Manual selectable  
Zoom ratio  
Horizontal resolution  
14×  
1000TV lines or more (with HQ 1080,  
Maximum relative aperture  
HD SDI output)  
1:1.9  
Gain  
Iris  
–3, 0, 3, 6, 9, 12, 18 dB, AGC  
Auto/Manual selectable  
F1.9 to F16 and C (close)  
Shutter speed  
1
1
/
to  
/
sec.  
32  
2000  
Focus  
Slow shutter  
2 to 8 frames  
EX Slow Shutter: 16, 32, 64 frames  
Auto/Manual selectable  
Ranges:  
800 mm to (Macro OFF)  
50 mm to (Macro ON, Wide)  
735 mm to (Macro ON, Tele)  
Audio Block  
Picture stabilizing function  
SteadyShot ON/OFF possible, shift-lens  
system  
Built-in microphones  
Stereo electret condenser microphones  
Directivity: Omnidirectional  
Specifications  
128  
   
Built-in speaker  
Analog composite/YC signals: NTSC or  
PAL  
Monaural  
Output: 250 mW  
COMPONENT OUT connector  
Mini D connector (1)  
Y: 1.0 Vp-p, 75Ω  
Pb / Pr: 0.7 Vp-p, 75Ω  
Displays  
LCD monitor  
Headphone connector  
Stereo mini jack (1), –20.5 dBu  
Screen size  
(reference level output, 16Ω load)  
8.8 cm diagonal (3.5-inch)  
SDI OUT connector  
Aspect ratio  
BNC type (1), conforming to  
16:9  
SMPTE292M/259M standards  
Picture size  
640 (H) × 3 (RGB) × 480 (V) delta  
sequence  
Computer connectors  
i.LINK (HDV) connector  
i.LINK, IEEE1394, 4-pin connector (1),  
Transmission  
Hybrid (semi-transmissive) type  
S400  
USB connector  
Viewfinder  
mini-B/USB2.0 Hi-Speed (1)  
Screen size  
1.4 cm diagonal (0.54-inch)  
Optional Accessories  
Aspect ratio  
16:9  
Battery pack  
BP-U30, BP-U60  
Battery charger  
Picture elements  
1120 (H) × 225 (V)  
BC-U1  
SxS memory card  
SxS PRO SBP-8 (8 GB), SBP-16 (16 GB)  
SxS memory card USB reader/writer  
SBAC-US10  
Electret condenser microphone  
ECM-673  
Inputs/Outputs  
Input connectors  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors  
XLR 3-pin (2), female  
LINE: +4 dBu  
Wide conversion lens  
VCL-EX0877  
MIC: –8 dBu to –65 dBu (3-dB steps)  
(Reference level: 0 dBu=0.775 Vrms)  
Design and specifications are subject to change  
without notice.  
DC IN connector  
DC jack (1)  
Output connectors  
A/V OUT connector  
AV multiconnector (1)  
Audio: –10 dBu (47kΩ load, reference  
level)  
Specifications  
129  
     
Dimensions  
1
Unit: mm (inches)  
(
)
380.8 13 /8  
OFF  
SEL/SET  
CANCEL  
CAMERA  
MEDIA  
DC IN  
LENS INFO BRT DISP HISTOGRAM  
ASSIGN  
MENU  
MENU  
AF/MF  
Full MF  
A
B
SLOT SELECT  
CH-1  
ACCESS  
1
2
3
PICTURE  
PROFILE  
IRIS  
ND  
FILTER  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
INT  
EXT  
CH-1  
CH-1  
MANU AUTO  
MACRO  
OPEN  
2
1
OPEN  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
AUDIO  
IN  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
AUTO  
INT  
EXT  
CH-2  
ZEBRA PEAKING FULL AUTO  
MANUAL  
CH-2  
CH-2  
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
PMW-EX1  
RELEASE  
OFF ON  
FOCUS  
CLOSE  
OPEN  
CLOSE  
OFF  
GAIN  
WHITE BAL  
L
M
H
B
A
PRST  
MANU AUTO  
PUSH AF  
9
(
1
1
)
6.6  
/
32  
(
)
(
)
264.6 10 /2  
178 7 /8  
40.2  
1 /8  
5
(
)
Notes  
• Always make a test recording, and verify that  
it was recorded successfully.  
SONY WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR  
DAMAGES OF ANY KIND INCLUDING,  
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, COMPENSATION  
OR REIMBURSEMENT ON ACCOUNT OF  
FAILURE OF THIS UNIT OR ITS  
RECORDING MEDIA, EXTERNAL  
STORAGE SYSTEMS OR ANY OTHER  
MEDIA OR STORAGE SYSTEMS TO  
RECORD CONTENT OF ANY TYPE.  
• Always verify that the unit is operating  
properly before use. SONY WILL NOT BE  
LIABLE FOR DAMAGES OF ANY KIND  
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
COMPENSATION OR REIMBURSEMENT  
ON ACCOUNT OF THE LOSS OF  
PRESENT OR PROSPECTIVE PROFITS  
DUE TO FAILURE OF THIS UNIT,  
EITHER DURING THE WARRANTY  
PERIOD OR AFTER EXPIRATION OF THE  
WARRANTY, OR FOR ANY OTHER  
REASON WHATSOEVER.  
Specifications  
130  
Battery Alarm 108  
Battery INFO 108  
BATTERY INFO display 23  
Battery Pack 22  
Index  
BATTERY RELEASE button 22  
BATTERY/MEDIA Status 93  
BC-U1 Battery Charger 22, 23  
Black 75  
Black Gamma 75  
BP-U30 22  
BP-U60 22  
BRT DISP 57  
BRT Disp 58  
built-in clock 24  
Built-in microphones 54  
Built-in speaker 81  
BUTTON/REMOTE Status 92  
Buzzer 123  
A
A/V OUT connector 111  
AC adaptor 23  
AC power source 23  
ACCESS lamps 31  
Accessory shoe 15  
add shot marks 87  
AF mode 50  
AGC mode 42  
All Clips DEL 76  
All Reset 77, 106  
Angle mode 43  
Area Detection 75  
Aspect Marker 40  
Aspect Select 40  
Assign Button 57, 107  
assignable buttons 57  
C
Camera Data 77, 106  
Camera mode 24  
CAMERA SET Menu 98  
CAMERA Status 90  
CANCEL button 83, 95  
Card slots 31  
ATW Speed 101  
Audio 54  
AUDIO IN connectors 54  
AUDIO IN switches 54  
Audio Input 102  
AUDIO LEVEL controls 54  
audio monitoring 55  
Audio Output 102  
audio recording levels 55  
AUDIO SELECT switches 54  
AUDIO Status 91  
Auto Focus 48  
Auto Iris mode 45  
Auto Shutter 44  
Auto Shutter mode 43  
Auto Tracing White 38  
Auto White Balance 39  
Center Marker 40  
CLIP INFO screen 84  
clip name 36  
Clip Operation menu 82, 83  
Clock mode 52  
Clock Set 107  
CMOS Image Sensors 117  
color bar 56  
Color Bar Type 99  
Color Correction 72  
COMPONENT OUT connector 110  
copy a clip 85  
COPY CLIP 85  
Country 109  
Cueing up 81  
B
Backlight 58  
D
backlight (EVF) 27  
backlight (LCD) 26  
backup battery 120  
BARS/CAM button 56  
Date/Time 24  
DC IN connector 23  
DC IN Power 23  
Index  
131  
 
delete a clip 85  
focus 48  
Focus ring 48  
Format Media 109  
Formatting 32  
DELETE CLIP 85  
delete shot marks 87  
Detail 73  
diopter compensation 26  
Direct Menu 108  
DISP CLIP INFO 84  
Display On/Off 105  
DISPLAY/BATT INFO button 19, 23  
divide a clip 88  
Frame Rec 100  
Frame Recording 60  
Free Run mode 52  
Freeze Mix 58, 63  
FULL AUTO button 34  
Full Auto mode 34  
Full Manual Focus 48  
Full MF mode 48  
DIVIDE CLIP 88  
Down Converter 103  
G
gain 42  
Gain Setup 42, 98  
GAIN switch 42  
Gamma 75  
Grip 28  
E
ECS 43  
EJECT buttons 31  
electronic shutter 43  
Electronic Viewfinder 26  
Entering a character string 97  
Error Indications 123  
EVF (menu) 27  
EVF Mode 58  
Guide Frame 40  
H
Headphone connector 55, 81  
high-speed playback 80  
HISTOGRAM 57  
Histogram 58  
EX Slow Shutter 43, 44, 98  
EXPAND CLIP 86  
EXPAND CLIP screen 85  
EXPAND FOCUS button 48  
Expanded Focus 58  
ExpressCard slot of a computer 111  
Extended Clear Scan 43  
external microphone 54  
external monitor 110  
eyecup 27  
Hooks for the shoulder strap 15  
Hours Meter 108  
I
i.LINK 125  
i.LINK cable 125  
i.LINK I/O 108, 114  
i.LINK(HDV) connector 114  
index frame 78, 88  
Interval Rec 100  
Interval Recording 58  
IR Remote 28, 58, 108  
IR Remote Commander 28  
iris 45  
Eyepiece focusing knob 27  
F
F FWD button 80  
F REV button 80  
Fade In 68, 69  
iris opening 45  
Iris ring 45  
Fade Out 68, 69  
Fixed gain mode 42  
Fixed Shutter mode 43  
Flicker Reduce 51, 99  
IRIS switch 45  
J
Jog dial 17, 95  
Joystick 16, 95  
Index  
132  
OTHERS Menu 106  
Output Formats 118  
K
Knee 74  
P
L
Peaking 49, 104  
Language 107  
PEAKING button 49  
PICTURE FROFILE menu 70, 72  
PICTURE PROFILE button 70  
Picture Profiles 70  
PLAY/PAUSE button 79  
Playback 79  
Power switch 24  
Power Zoom 46  
Power Zoom (Servo) mode 46  
Power zoom lever 47  
PREV button 81  
Last Clip DEL 58, 76  
LCD B.LIGHT + and – buttons 26  
LCD B.LIGHT switch 26  
LCD monitor 25  
LCD/VF SET Menu 104  
lens cap 34  
Lens hood 14  
LENS INFO 57  
Lens Info 58  
LENS REMOTE connector 47  
LINE/MIC/+48V switches 54  
Low Key SAT 75  
Profile Name 72  
PUSH AF button 49  
R
M
Range index 48  
Macro mode 50  
MACRO switch 50  
Manual Focus 48  
Manual Iris mode 45  
Manual Zoom mode 46  
Matrix 72  
Rec 58  
REC HOLD lever 35  
Rec Review 35, 57, 58, 100  
REC REVIEW button 35, 57  
Rec Run mode 52  
REC START/STOP button 35  
Recall 77  
reference tone 56  
Regen mode 52  
RELEASE button 28  
restoration 33  
MEDIA 78  
Media mode 24  
MENU button 95  
Menu controls 95  
MF Assist 49, 99  
MF mode 49  
microphone holder 54  
MONITOR VOL buttons 55, 81  
S
S&Q Motion 61, 100  
Safety Area 40  
Safety Zone 40  
SBAC-US10 112  
SBP-16 30  
N
ND filter switch 37  
ND filters 37  
NDF 52  
SBP-8 30  
SDI OUT connector 110  
SEL/SET button 95  
SEL/SET dial 95  
SET INDEX PIC 88  
Setup 103  
NEXT button 81  
O
OK mark 84  
OK MARK ADD 84  
OK MARK DEL 85  
One-Push Auto Focusing 49  
setup file 77  
Setup menus 94  
Index  
133  
Shockless White 101  
SHOT MARK 86  
SHOT MARK screen 86  
SHOT MARK1 86  
Shot Mark1 58  
U
USB cable 112  
user bits 53  
Users Bit 106  
SHOT MARK1 ADD 87  
SHOT MARK1 DEL 87  
SHOT MARK2 86  
Shot Mark2 58  
SHOT MARK2 ADD 87  
SHOT MARK2 DEL 87  
shot marks 56, 81  
Shot Transition 64, 99  
Shutter 43, 98  
SHUTTER switch 43  
Skin Tone Detail 74  
SLOT SELECT button 31, 79  
Slow & Quick Motion 61  
Slow Shutter 43  
SLS 43  
Speed mode 43  
Spotlight 58  
STATUS button 89  
status screens 89  
Steady Shot 51, 102  
STOP button 81  
Store 77  
V
Video Format 36, 109  
Video Out Display 103  
VIDEO Status 92  
Viewfinder 26  
Viewfinder release lever 116  
W
Warning Indications 123  
White 73  
WHITE BAL switch 38  
white balance 38  
White Switch 101  
WHT BAL button 39  
Wide Conversion 101  
wide-conversion lens 51  
write protection 30  
X
XDCAM EX Clip Browsing Software 13,  
SxS Device Driver Software 13, 111  
SxS memory cards 30  
Y
YPbPr/SDI Out Display 103  
YPbPr/SDI Out Select 103  
T
Tally 108  
Z
Tally lamps 123  
TC Format 52, 106  
TC/UB SET Menu 106  
TC/U-BIT/DURATION button 53, 80  
THUMBNAIL button 79, 81  
Thumbnail Screen 78  
Time Zone 24, 106  
Timecode 106  
TRANSITION operation buttons 64  
Trigger Mode 109  
ZEBRA button 41  
zebra patterns 41  
Zebra Select 41  
Zebra1 Level 41  
zoom 46  
ZOOM button 47  
Zoom Position 46  
Zoom ring 46  
Zoom Speed 99  
Zoom speed switch 47  
ZOOM switch 46  
Tripod receptacle 18  
Troubleshooting 121  
Index  
134  

West Bend L5700 User Manual
ViewSonic Car Video System VX715 User Manual
Star Manufacturing Ultra Max Lava Rock Gas Char Broilers 8072CB User Manual
Sony CFS 616L User Manual
Sony CCD TRV57 User Manual
Sony Car Stereo System XR C6100 User Manual
Sony Camcorder CCD TR70 User Manual
Sherwood BDP 5004 User Manual
Sanyo LNS W31A User Manual
Samsung Cash Register M ER290 User Manual